1 /* Variable tracking routines for the GNU compiler.
2 Copyright (C) 2002-2023 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 This file is part of GCC.
6 GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
7 under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
8 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option)
11 GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT
12 ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY
13 or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public
14 License for more details.
16 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
17 along with GCC; see the file COPYING3. If not see
18 <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
20 /* This file contains the variable tracking pass. It computes where
21 variables are located (which registers or where in memory) at each position
22 in instruction stream and emits notes describing the locations.
23 Debug information (DWARF2 location lists) is finally generated from
25 With this debug information, it is possible to show variables
26 even when debugging optimized code.
28 How does the variable tracking pass work?
30 First, it scans RTL code for uses, stores and clobbers (register/memory
31 references in instructions), for call insns and for stack adjustments
32 separately for each basic block and saves them to an array of micro
34 The micro operations of one instruction are ordered so that
35 pre-modifying stack adjustment < use < use with no var < call insn <
36 < clobber < set < post-modifying stack adjustment
38 Then, a forward dataflow analysis is performed to find out how locations
39 of variables change through code and to propagate the variable locations
40 along control flow graph.
41 The IN set for basic block BB is computed as a union of OUT sets of BB's
42 predecessors, the OUT set for BB is copied from the IN set for BB and
43 is changed according to micro operations in BB.
45 The IN and OUT sets for basic blocks consist of a current stack adjustment
46 (used for adjusting offset of variables addressed using stack pointer),
47 the table of structures describing the locations of parts of a variable
48 and for each physical register a linked list for each physical register.
49 The linked list is a list of variable parts stored in the register,
50 i.e. it is a list of triplets (reg, decl, offset) where decl is
51 REG_EXPR (reg) and offset is REG_OFFSET (reg). The linked list is used for
52 effective deleting appropriate variable parts when we set or clobber the
55 There may be more than one variable part in a register. The linked lists
56 should be pretty short so it is a good data structure here.
57 For example in the following code, register allocator may assign same
58 register to variables A and B, and both of them are stored in the same
71 Finally, the NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION notes describing the variable locations
72 are emitted to appropriate positions in RTL code. Each such a note describes
73 the location of one variable at the point in instruction stream where the
74 note is. There is no need to emit a note for each variable before each
75 instruction, we only emit these notes where the location of variable changes
76 (this means that we also emit notes for changes between the OUT set of the
77 previous block and the IN set of the current block).
79 The notes consist of two parts:
80 1. the declaration (from REG_EXPR or MEM_EXPR)
81 2. the location of a variable - it is either a simple register/memory
82 reference (for simple variables, for example int),
83 or a parallel of register/memory references (for a large variables
84 which consist of several parts, for example long long).
90 #include "coretypes.h"
96 #include "alloc-pool.h"
97 #include "tree-pass.h"
100 #include "insn-config.h"
102 #include "emit-rtl.h"
104 #include "diagnostic.h"
106 #include "stor-layout.h"
111 #include "tree-dfa.h"
112 #include "tree-ssa.h"
114 #include "tree-pretty-print.h"
115 #include "rtl-iter.h"
116 #include "fibonacci_heap.h"
117 #include "print-rtl.h"
118 #include "function-abi.h"
120 typedef fibonacci_heap
<long, basic_block_def
> bb_heap_t
;
122 /* var-tracking.cc assumes that tree code with the same value as VALUE rtx code
123 has no chance to appear in REG_EXPR/MEM_EXPRs and isn't a decl.
124 Currently the value is the same as IDENTIFIER_NODE, which has such
125 a property. If this compile time assertion ever fails, make sure that
126 the new tree code that equals (int) VALUE has the same property. */
127 extern char check_value_val
[(int) VALUE
== (int) IDENTIFIER_NODE
? 1 : -1];
129 /* Type of micro operation. */
130 enum micro_operation_type
132 MO_USE
, /* Use location (REG or MEM). */
133 MO_USE_NO_VAR
,/* Use location which is not associated with a variable
134 or the variable is not trackable. */
135 MO_VAL_USE
, /* Use location which is associated with a value. */
136 MO_VAL_LOC
, /* Use location which appears in a debug insn. */
137 MO_VAL_SET
, /* Set location associated with a value. */
138 MO_SET
, /* Set location. */
139 MO_COPY
, /* Copy the same portion of a variable from one
140 location to another. */
141 MO_CLOBBER
, /* Clobber location. */
142 MO_CALL
, /* Call insn. */
143 MO_ADJUST
/* Adjust stack pointer. */
147 static const char * const ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
148 micro_operation_type_name
[] = {
161 /* Where shall the note be emitted? BEFORE or AFTER the instruction.
162 Notes emitted as AFTER_CALL are to take effect during the call,
163 rather than after the call. */
166 EMIT_NOTE_BEFORE_INSN
,
167 EMIT_NOTE_AFTER_INSN
,
168 EMIT_NOTE_AFTER_CALL_INSN
171 /* Structure holding information about micro operation. */
172 struct micro_operation
174 /* Type of micro operation. */
175 enum micro_operation_type type
;
177 /* The instruction which the micro operation is in, for MO_USE,
178 MO_USE_NO_VAR, MO_CALL and MO_ADJUST, or the subsequent
179 instruction or note in the original flow (before any var-tracking
180 notes are inserted, to simplify emission of notes), for MO_SET
185 /* Location. For MO_SET and MO_COPY, this is the SET that
186 performs the assignment, if known, otherwise it is the target
187 of the assignment. For MO_VAL_USE and MO_VAL_SET, it is a
188 CONCAT of the VALUE and the LOC associated with it. For
189 MO_VAL_LOC, it is a CONCAT of the VALUE and the VAR_LOCATION
190 associated with it. */
193 /* Stack adjustment. */
194 HOST_WIDE_INT adjust
;
199 /* A declaration of a variable, or an RTL value being handled like a
201 typedef void *decl_or_value
;
203 /* Return true if a decl_or_value DV is a DECL or NULL. */
205 dv_is_decl_p (decl_or_value dv
)
207 return !dv
|| (int) TREE_CODE ((tree
) dv
) != (int) VALUE
;
210 /* Return true if a decl_or_value is a VALUE rtl. */
212 dv_is_value_p (decl_or_value dv
)
214 return dv
&& !dv_is_decl_p (dv
);
217 /* Return the decl in the decl_or_value. */
219 dv_as_decl (decl_or_value dv
)
221 gcc_checking_assert (dv_is_decl_p (dv
));
225 /* Return the value in the decl_or_value. */
227 dv_as_value (decl_or_value dv
)
229 gcc_checking_assert (dv_is_value_p (dv
));
233 /* Return the opaque pointer in the decl_or_value. */
235 dv_as_opaque (decl_or_value dv
)
241 /* Description of location of a part of a variable. The content of a physical
242 register is described by a chain of these structures.
243 The chains are pretty short (usually 1 or 2 elements) and thus
244 chain is the best data structure. */
247 /* Pointer to next member of the list. */
250 /* The rtx of register. */
253 /* The declaration corresponding to LOC. */
256 /* Offset from start of DECL. */
257 HOST_WIDE_INT offset
;
260 /* Structure for chaining the locations. */
261 struct location_chain
263 /* Next element in the chain. */
264 location_chain
*next
;
266 /* The location (REG, MEM or VALUE). */
269 /* The "value" stored in this location. */
273 enum var_init_status init
;
276 /* A vector of loc_exp_dep holds the active dependencies of a one-part
277 DV on VALUEs, i.e., the VALUEs expanded so as to form the current
278 location of DV. Each entry is also part of VALUE' s linked-list of
279 backlinks back to DV. */
282 /* The dependent DV. */
284 /* The dependency VALUE or DECL_DEBUG. */
286 /* The next entry in VALUE's backlinks list. */
287 struct loc_exp_dep
*next
;
288 /* A pointer to the pointer to this entry (head or prev's next) in
289 the doubly-linked list. */
290 struct loc_exp_dep
**pprev
;
294 /* This data structure holds information about the depth of a variable
298 /* This measures the complexity of the expanded expression. It
299 grows by one for each level of expansion that adds more than one
302 /* This counts the number of ENTRY_VALUE expressions in an
303 expansion. We want to minimize their use. */
307 /* Type for dependencies actively used when expand FROM into cur_loc. */
308 typedef vec
<loc_exp_dep
, va_heap
, vl_embed
> deps_vec
;
310 /* This data structure is allocated for one-part variables at the time
311 of emitting notes. */
314 /* Doubly-linked list of dependent DVs. These are DVs whose cur_loc
315 computation used the expansion of this variable, and that ought
316 to be notified should this variable change. If the DV's cur_loc
317 expanded to NULL, all components of the loc list are regarded as
318 active, so that any changes in them give us a chance to get a
319 location. Otherwise, only components of the loc that expanded to
320 non-NULL are regarded as active dependencies. */
321 loc_exp_dep
*backlinks
;
322 /* This holds the LOC that was expanded into cur_loc. We need only
323 mark a one-part variable as changed if the FROM loc is removed,
324 or if it has no known location and a loc is added, or if it gets
325 a change notification from any of its active dependencies. */
327 /* The depth of the cur_loc expression. */
329 /* Dependencies actively used when expand FROM into cur_loc. */
333 /* Structure describing one part of variable. */
336 /* Chain of locations of the part. */
337 location_chain
*loc_chain
;
339 /* Location which was last emitted to location list. */
344 /* The offset in the variable, if !var->onepart. */
345 HOST_WIDE_INT offset
;
347 /* Pointer to auxiliary data, if var->onepart and emit_notes. */
348 struct onepart_aux
*onepaux
;
352 /* Maximum number of location parts. */
353 #define MAX_VAR_PARTS 16
355 /* Enumeration type used to discriminate various types of one-part
359 /* Not a one-part variable. */
361 /* A one-part DECL that is not a DEBUG_EXPR_DECL. */
363 /* A DEBUG_EXPR_DECL. */
369 /* Structure describing where the variable is located. */
372 /* The declaration of the variable, or an RTL value being handled
373 like a declaration. */
376 /* Reference count. */
379 /* Number of variable parts. */
382 /* What type of DV this is, according to enum onepart_enum. */
383 ENUM_BITFIELD (onepart_enum
) onepart
: CHAR_BIT
;
385 /* True if this variable_def struct is currently in the
386 changed_variables hash table. */
387 bool in_changed_variables
;
389 /* The variable parts. */
390 variable_part var_part
[1];
393 /* Pointer to the BB's information specific to variable tracking pass. */
394 #define VTI(BB) ((variable_tracking_info *) (BB)->aux)
396 /* Return MEM_OFFSET (MEM) as a HOST_WIDE_INT, or 0 if we can't. */
398 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
399 int_mem_offset (const_rtx mem
)
401 HOST_WIDE_INT offset
;
402 if (MEM_OFFSET_KNOWN_P (mem
) && MEM_OFFSET (mem
).is_constant (&offset
))
407 #if CHECKING_P && (GCC_VERSION >= 2007)
409 /* Access VAR's Ith part's offset, checking that it's not a one-part
411 #define VAR_PART_OFFSET(var, i) __extension__ \
412 (*({ variable *const __v = (var); \
413 gcc_checking_assert (!__v->onepart); \
414 &__v->var_part[(i)].aux.offset; }))
416 /* Access VAR's one-part auxiliary data, checking that it is a
417 one-part variable. */
418 #define VAR_LOC_1PAUX(var) __extension__ \
419 (*({ variable *const __v = (var); \
420 gcc_checking_assert (__v->onepart); \
421 &__v->var_part[0].aux.onepaux; }))
424 #define VAR_PART_OFFSET(var, i) ((var)->var_part[(i)].aux.offset)
425 #define VAR_LOC_1PAUX(var) ((var)->var_part[0].aux.onepaux)
428 /* These are accessor macros for the one-part auxiliary data. When
429 convenient for users, they're guarded by tests that the data was
431 #define VAR_LOC_DEP_LST(var) (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var) \
432 ? VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var)->backlinks \
434 #define VAR_LOC_DEP_LSTP(var) (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var) \
435 ? &VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var)->backlinks \
437 #define VAR_LOC_FROM(var) (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var)->from)
438 #define VAR_LOC_DEPTH(var) (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var)->depth)
439 #define VAR_LOC_DEP_VEC(var) var_loc_dep_vec (var)
441 /* Implements the VAR_LOC_DEP_VEC above as a function to work around
442 a bogus -Wnonnull (PR c/95554). */
444 static inline deps_vec
*
445 var_loc_dep_vec (variable
*var
)
447 return VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
) ? &VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
)->deps
: NULL
;
451 typedef unsigned int dvuid
;
453 /* Return the uid of DV. */
456 dv_uid (decl_or_value dv
)
458 if (dv_is_value_p (dv
))
459 return CSELIB_VAL_PTR (dv_as_value (dv
))->uid
;
461 return DECL_UID (dv_as_decl (dv
));
464 /* Compute the hash from the uid. */
466 static inline hashval_t
467 dv_uid2hash (dvuid uid
)
472 /* The hash function for a mask table in a shared_htab chain. */
474 static inline hashval_t
475 dv_htab_hash (decl_or_value dv
)
477 return dv_uid2hash (dv_uid (dv
));
480 static void variable_htab_free (void *);
482 /* Variable hashtable helpers. */
484 struct variable_hasher
: pointer_hash
<variable
>
486 typedef void *compare_type
;
487 static inline hashval_t
hash (const variable
*);
488 static inline bool equal (const variable
*, const void *);
489 static inline void remove (variable
*);
492 /* The hash function for variable_htab, computes the hash value
493 from the declaration of variable X. */
496 variable_hasher::hash (const variable
*v
)
498 return dv_htab_hash (v
->dv
);
501 /* Compare the declaration of variable X with declaration Y. */
504 variable_hasher::equal (const variable
*v
, const void *y
)
506 decl_or_value dv
= CONST_CAST2 (decl_or_value
, const void *, y
);
508 return (dv_as_opaque (v
->dv
) == dv_as_opaque (dv
));
511 /* Free the element of VARIABLE_HTAB (its type is struct variable_def). */
514 variable_hasher::remove (variable
*var
)
516 variable_htab_free (var
);
519 typedef hash_table
<variable_hasher
> variable_table_type
;
520 typedef variable_table_type::iterator variable_iterator_type
;
522 /* Structure for passing some other parameters to function
523 emit_note_insn_var_location. */
524 struct emit_note_data
526 /* The instruction which the note will be emitted before/after. */
529 /* Where the note will be emitted (before/after insn)? */
530 enum emit_note_where where
;
532 /* The variables and values active at this point. */
533 variable_table_type
*vars
;
536 /* Structure holding a refcounted hash table. If refcount > 1,
537 it must be first unshared before modified. */
540 /* Reference count. */
543 /* Actual hash table. */
544 variable_table_type
*htab
;
547 /* Structure holding the IN or OUT set for a basic block. */
550 /* Adjustment of stack offset. */
551 HOST_WIDE_INT stack_adjust
;
553 /* Attributes for registers (lists of attrs). */
554 attrs
*regs
[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
];
556 /* Variable locations. */
559 /* Vars that is being traversed. */
560 shared_hash
*traversed_vars
;
563 /* The structure (one for each basic block) containing the information
564 needed for variable tracking. */
565 struct variable_tracking_info
567 /* The vector of micro operations. */
568 vec
<micro_operation
> mos
;
570 /* The IN and OUT set for dataflow analysis. */
574 /* The permanent-in dataflow set for this block. This is used to
575 hold values for which we had to compute entry values. ??? This
576 should probably be dynamically allocated, to avoid using more
577 memory in non-debug builds. */
580 /* Has the block been visited in DFS? */
583 /* Has the block been flooded in VTA? */
588 /* Alloc pool for struct attrs_def. */
589 object_allocator
<attrs
> attrs_pool ("attrs pool");
591 /* Alloc pool for struct variable_def with MAX_VAR_PARTS entries. */
593 static pool_allocator var_pool
594 ("variable_def pool", sizeof (variable
) +
595 (MAX_VAR_PARTS
- 1) * sizeof (((variable
*)NULL
)->var_part
[0]));
597 /* Alloc pool for struct variable_def with a single var_part entry. */
598 static pool_allocator valvar_pool
599 ("small variable_def pool", sizeof (variable
));
601 /* Alloc pool for struct location_chain. */
602 static object_allocator
<location_chain
> location_chain_pool
603 ("location_chain pool");
605 /* Alloc pool for struct shared_hash. */
606 static object_allocator
<shared_hash
> shared_hash_pool ("shared_hash pool");
608 /* Alloc pool for struct loc_exp_dep_s for NOT_ONEPART variables. */
609 object_allocator
<loc_exp_dep
> loc_exp_dep_pool ("loc_exp_dep pool");
611 /* Changed variables, notes will be emitted for them. */
612 static variable_table_type
*changed_variables
;
614 /* Shall notes be emitted? */
615 static bool emit_notes
;
617 /* Values whose dynamic location lists have gone empty, but whose
618 cselib location lists are still usable. Use this to hold the
619 current location, the backlinks, etc, during emit_notes. */
620 static variable_table_type
*dropped_values
;
622 /* Empty shared hashtable. */
623 static shared_hash
*empty_shared_hash
;
625 /* Scratch register bitmap used by cselib_expand_value_rtx. */
626 static bitmap scratch_regs
= NULL
;
628 #ifdef HAVE_window_save
629 struct GTY(()) parm_reg
{
635 /* Vector of windowed parameter registers, if any. */
636 static vec
<parm_reg
, va_gc
> *windowed_parm_regs
= NULL
;
639 /* Variable used to tell whether cselib_process_insn called our hook. */
640 static bool cselib_hook_called
;
642 /* Local function prototypes. */
643 static void stack_adjust_offset_pre_post (rtx
, HOST_WIDE_INT
*,
645 static void insn_stack_adjust_offset_pre_post (rtx_insn
*, HOST_WIDE_INT
*,
647 static bool vt_stack_adjustments (void);
649 static void init_attrs_list_set (attrs
**);
650 static void attrs_list_clear (attrs
**);
651 static attrs
*attrs_list_member (attrs
*, decl_or_value
, HOST_WIDE_INT
);
652 static void attrs_list_insert (attrs
**, decl_or_value
, HOST_WIDE_INT
, rtx
);
653 static void attrs_list_copy (attrs
**, attrs
*);
654 static void attrs_list_union (attrs
**, attrs
*);
656 static variable
**unshare_variable (dataflow_set
*set
, variable
**slot
,
657 variable
*var
, enum var_init_status
);
658 static void vars_copy (variable_table_type
*, variable_table_type
*);
659 static tree
var_debug_decl (tree
);
660 static void var_reg_set (dataflow_set
*, rtx
, enum var_init_status
, rtx
);
661 static void var_reg_delete_and_set (dataflow_set
*, rtx
, bool,
662 enum var_init_status
, rtx
);
663 static void var_reg_delete (dataflow_set
*, rtx
, bool);
664 static void var_regno_delete (dataflow_set
*, int);
665 static void var_mem_set (dataflow_set
*, rtx
, enum var_init_status
, rtx
);
666 static void var_mem_delete_and_set (dataflow_set
*, rtx
, bool,
667 enum var_init_status
, rtx
);
668 static void var_mem_delete (dataflow_set
*, rtx
, bool);
670 static void dataflow_set_init (dataflow_set
*);
671 static void dataflow_set_clear (dataflow_set
*);
672 static void dataflow_set_copy (dataflow_set
*, dataflow_set
*);
673 static int variable_union_info_cmp_pos (const void *, const void *);
674 static void dataflow_set_union (dataflow_set
*, dataflow_set
*);
675 static location_chain
*find_loc_in_1pdv (rtx
, variable
*,
676 variable_table_type
*);
677 static bool canon_value_cmp (rtx
, rtx
);
678 static int loc_cmp (rtx
, rtx
);
679 static bool variable_part_different_p (variable_part
*, variable_part
*);
680 static bool onepart_variable_different_p (variable
*, variable
*);
681 static bool variable_different_p (variable
*, variable
*);
682 static bool dataflow_set_different (dataflow_set
*, dataflow_set
*);
683 static void dataflow_set_destroy (dataflow_set
*);
685 static bool track_expr_p (tree
, bool);
686 static void add_uses_1 (rtx
*, void *);
687 static void add_stores (rtx
, const_rtx
, void *);
688 static bool compute_bb_dataflow (basic_block
);
689 static bool vt_find_locations (void);
691 static void dump_attrs_list (attrs
*);
692 static void dump_var (variable
*);
693 static void dump_vars (variable_table_type
*);
694 static void dump_dataflow_set (dataflow_set
*);
695 static void dump_dataflow_sets (void);
697 static void set_dv_changed (decl_or_value
, bool);
698 static void variable_was_changed (variable
*, dataflow_set
*);
699 static variable
**set_slot_part (dataflow_set
*, rtx
, variable
**,
700 decl_or_value
, HOST_WIDE_INT
,
701 enum var_init_status
, rtx
);
702 static void set_variable_part (dataflow_set
*, rtx
,
703 decl_or_value
, HOST_WIDE_INT
,
704 enum var_init_status
, rtx
, enum insert_option
);
705 static variable
**clobber_slot_part (dataflow_set
*, rtx
,
706 variable
**, HOST_WIDE_INT
, rtx
);
707 static void clobber_variable_part (dataflow_set
*, rtx
,
708 decl_or_value
, HOST_WIDE_INT
, rtx
);
709 static variable
**delete_slot_part (dataflow_set
*, rtx
, variable
**,
711 static void delete_variable_part (dataflow_set
*, rtx
,
712 decl_or_value
, HOST_WIDE_INT
);
713 static void emit_notes_in_bb (basic_block
, dataflow_set
*);
714 static void vt_emit_notes (void);
716 static void vt_add_function_parameters (void);
717 static bool vt_initialize (void);
718 static void vt_finalize (void);
720 /* Callback for stack_adjust_offset_pre_post, called via for_each_inc_dec. */
723 stack_adjust_offset_pre_post_cb (rtx
, rtx op
, rtx dest
, rtx src
, rtx srcoff
,
726 if (dest
!= stack_pointer_rtx
)
729 switch (GET_CODE (op
))
733 ((HOST_WIDE_INT
*)arg
)[0] -= INTVAL (srcoff
);
737 ((HOST_WIDE_INT
*)arg
)[1] -= INTVAL (srcoff
);
741 /* We handle only adjustments by constant amount. */
742 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (src
) == PLUS
743 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (src
, 1))
744 && XEXP (src
, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx
);
745 ((HOST_WIDE_INT
*)arg
)[GET_CODE (op
) == POST_MODIFY
]
746 -= INTVAL (XEXP (src
, 1));
753 /* Given a SET, calculate the amount of stack adjustment it contains
754 PRE- and POST-modifying stack pointer.
755 This function is similar to stack_adjust_offset. */
758 stack_adjust_offset_pre_post (rtx pattern
, HOST_WIDE_INT
*pre
,
761 rtx src
= SET_SRC (pattern
);
762 rtx dest
= SET_DEST (pattern
);
765 if (dest
== stack_pointer_rtx
)
767 /* (set (reg sp) (plus (reg sp) (const_int))) */
768 code
= GET_CODE (src
);
769 if (! (code
== PLUS
|| code
== MINUS
)
770 || XEXP (src
, 0) != stack_pointer_rtx
771 || !CONST_INT_P (XEXP (src
, 1)))
775 *post
+= INTVAL (XEXP (src
, 1));
777 *post
-= INTVAL (XEXP (src
, 1));
780 HOST_WIDE_INT res
[2] = { 0, 0 };
781 for_each_inc_dec (pattern
, stack_adjust_offset_pre_post_cb
, res
);
786 /* Given an INSN, calculate the amount of stack adjustment it contains
787 PRE- and POST-modifying stack pointer. */
790 insn_stack_adjust_offset_pre_post (rtx_insn
*insn
, HOST_WIDE_INT
*pre
,
798 pattern
= PATTERN (insn
);
799 if (RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn
))
801 rtx expr
= find_reg_note (insn
, REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR
, NULL_RTX
);
803 pattern
= XEXP (expr
, 0);
806 if (GET_CODE (pattern
) == SET
)
807 stack_adjust_offset_pre_post (pattern
, pre
, post
);
808 else if (GET_CODE (pattern
) == PARALLEL
809 || GET_CODE (pattern
) == SEQUENCE
)
813 /* There may be stack adjustments inside compound insns. Search
815 for ( i
= XVECLEN (pattern
, 0) - 1; i
>= 0; i
--)
816 if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (pattern
, 0, i
)) == SET
)
817 stack_adjust_offset_pre_post (XVECEXP (pattern
, 0, i
), pre
, post
);
821 /* Compute stack adjustments for all blocks by traversing DFS tree.
822 Return true when the adjustments on all incoming edges are consistent.
823 Heavily borrowed from pre_and_rev_post_order_compute. */
826 vt_stack_adjustments (void)
828 edge_iterator
*stack
;
831 /* Initialize entry block. */
832 VTI (ENTRY_BLOCK_PTR_FOR_FN (cfun
))->visited
= true;
833 VTI (ENTRY_BLOCK_PTR_FOR_FN (cfun
))->in
.stack_adjust
834 = INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
;
835 VTI (ENTRY_BLOCK_PTR_FOR_FN (cfun
))->out
.stack_adjust
836 = INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
;
838 /* Allocate stack for back-tracking up CFG. */
839 stack
= XNEWVEC (edge_iterator
, n_basic_blocks_for_fn (cfun
) + 1);
842 /* Push the first edge on to the stack. */
843 stack
[sp
++] = ei_start (ENTRY_BLOCK_PTR_FOR_FN (cfun
)->succs
);
851 /* Look at the edge on the top of the stack. */
853 src
= ei_edge (ei
)->src
;
854 dest
= ei_edge (ei
)->dest
;
856 /* Check if the edge destination has been visited yet. */
857 if (!VTI (dest
)->visited
)
860 HOST_WIDE_INT pre
, post
, offset
;
861 VTI (dest
)->visited
= true;
862 VTI (dest
)->in
.stack_adjust
= offset
= VTI (src
)->out
.stack_adjust
;
864 if (dest
!= EXIT_BLOCK_PTR_FOR_FN (cfun
))
865 for (insn
= BB_HEAD (dest
);
866 insn
!= NEXT_INSN (BB_END (dest
));
867 insn
= NEXT_INSN (insn
))
870 insn_stack_adjust_offset_pre_post (insn
, &pre
, &post
);
871 offset
+= pre
+ post
;
874 VTI (dest
)->out
.stack_adjust
= offset
;
876 if (EDGE_COUNT (dest
->succs
) > 0)
877 /* Since the DEST node has been visited for the first
878 time, check its successors. */
879 stack
[sp
++] = ei_start (dest
->succs
);
883 /* We can end up with different stack adjustments for the exit block
884 of a shrink-wrapped function if stack_adjust_offset_pre_post
885 doesn't understand the rtx pattern used to restore the stack
886 pointer in the epilogue. For example, on s390(x), the stack
887 pointer is often restored via a load-multiple instruction
888 and so no stack_adjust offset is recorded for it. This means
889 that the stack offset at the end of the epilogue block is the
890 same as the offset before the epilogue, whereas other paths
891 to the exit block will have the correct stack_adjust.
893 It is safe to ignore these differences because (a) we never
894 use the stack_adjust for the exit block in this pass and
895 (b) dwarf2cfi checks whether the CFA notes in a shrink-wrapped
896 function are correct.
898 We must check whether the adjustments on other edges are
900 if (dest
!= EXIT_BLOCK_PTR_FOR_FN (cfun
)
901 && VTI (dest
)->in
.stack_adjust
!= VTI (src
)->out
.stack_adjust
)
907 if (! ei_one_before_end_p (ei
))
908 /* Go to the next edge. */
909 ei_next (&stack
[sp
- 1]);
911 /* Return to previous level if there are no more edges. */
920 /* arg_pointer_rtx resp. frame_pointer_rtx if stack_pointer_rtx or
921 hard_frame_pointer_rtx is being mapped to it and offset for it. */
922 static rtx cfa_base_rtx
;
923 static HOST_WIDE_INT cfa_base_offset
;
925 /* Compute a CFA-based value for an ADJUSTMENT made to stack_pointer_rtx
926 or hard_frame_pointer_rtx. */
929 compute_cfa_pointer (poly_int64 adjustment
)
931 return plus_constant (Pmode
, cfa_base_rtx
, adjustment
+ cfa_base_offset
);
934 /* Adjustment for hard_frame_pointer_rtx to cfa base reg,
935 or -1 if the replacement shouldn't be done. */
936 static poly_int64 hard_frame_pointer_adjustment
= -1;
938 /* Data for adjust_mems callback. */
940 class adjust_mem_data
944 machine_mode mem_mode
;
945 HOST_WIDE_INT stack_adjust
;
946 auto_vec
<rtx
> side_effects
;
949 /* Helper for adjust_mems. Return true if X is suitable for
950 transformation of wider mode arithmetics to narrower mode. */
953 use_narrower_mode_test (rtx x
, const_rtx subreg
)
955 subrtx_var_iterator::array_type array
;
956 FOR_EACH_SUBRTX_VAR (iter
, array
, x
, NONCONST
)
960 iter
.skip_subrtxes ();
962 switch (GET_CODE (x
))
965 if (cselib_lookup (x
, GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (subreg
)), 0, VOIDmode
))
967 if (!validate_subreg (GET_MODE (subreg
), GET_MODE (x
), x
,
968 subreg_lowpart_offset (GET_MODE (subreg
),
977 if (GET_MODE (XEXP (x
, 1)) != VOIDmode
)
979 enum machine_mode mode
= GET_MODE (subreg
);
980 rtx op1
= XEXP (x
, 1);
981 enum machine_mode op1_mode
= GET_MODE (op1
);
982 if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (as_a
<scalar_int_mode
> (mode
))
983 < GET_MODE_PRECISION (as_a
<scalar_int_mode
> (op1_mode
)))
985 poly_uint64 byte
= subreg_lowpart_offset (mode
, op1_mode
);
986 if (GET_CODE (op1
) == SUBREG
|| GET_CODE (op1
) == CONCAT
)
988 if (!simplify_subreg (mode
, op1
, op1_mode
, byte
))
991 else if (!validate_subreg (mode
, op1_mode
, op1
, byte
))
995 iter
.substitute (XEXP (x
, 0));
1004 /* Transform X into narrower mode MODE from wider mode WMODE. */
1007 use_narrower_mode (rtx x
, scalar_int_mode mode
, scalar_int_mode wmode
)
1011 return lowpart_subreg (mode
, x
, wmode
);
1012 switch (GET_CODE (x
))
1015 return lowpart_subreg (mode
, x
, wmode
);
1019 op0
= use_narrower_mode (XEXP (x
, 0), mode
, wmode
);
1020 op1
= use_narrower_mode (XEXP (x
, 1), mode
, wmode
);
1021 return simplify_gen_binary (GET_CODE (x
), mode
, op0
, op1
);
1023 op0
= use_narrower_mode (XEXP (x
, 0), mode
, wmode
);
1025 /* Ensure shift amount is not wider than mode. */
1026 if (GET_MODE (op1
) == VOIDmode
)
1027 op1
= lowpart_subreg (mode
, op1
, wmode
);
1028 else if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode
)
1029 < GET_MODE_PRECISION (as_a
<scalar_int_mode
> (GET_MODE (op1
))))
1030 op1
= lowpart_subreg (mode
, op1
, GET_MODE (op1
));
1031 return simplify_gen_binary (ASHIFT
, mode
, op0
, op1
);
1037 /* Helper function for adjusting used MEMs. */
1040 adjust_mems (rtx loc
, const_rtx old_rtx
, void *data
)
1042 class adjust_mem_data
*amd
= (class adjust_mem_data
*) data
;
1043 rtx mem
, addr
= loc
, tem
;
1044 machine_mode mem_mode_save
;
1046 scalar_int_mode tem_mode
, tem_subreg_mode
;
1048 switch (GET_CODE (loc
))
1051 /* Don't do any sp or fp replacements outside of MEM addresses
1053 if (amd
->mem_mode
== VOIDmode
&& amd
->store
)
1055 if (loc
== stack_pointer_rtx
1056 && !frame_pointer_needed
1058 return compute_cfa_pointer (amd
->stack_adjust
);
1059 else if (loc
== hard_frame_pointer_rtx
1060 && frame_pointer_needed
1061 && maybe_ne (hard_frame_pointer_adjustment
, -1)
1063 return compute_cfa_pointer (hard_frame_pointer_adjustment
);
1064 gcc_checking_assert (loc
!= virtual_incoming_args_rtx
);
1070 mem
= targetm
.delegitimize_address (mem
);
1071 if (mem
!= loc
&& !MEM_P (mem
))
1072 return simplify_replace_fn_rtx (mem
, old_rtx
, adjust_mems
, data
);
1075 addr
= XEXP (mem
, 0);
1076 mem_mode_save
= amd
->mem_mode
;
1077 amd
->mem_mode
= GET_MODE (mem
);
1078 store_save
= amd
->store
;
1080 addr
= simplify_replace_fn_rtx (addr
, old_rtx
, adjust_mems
, data
);
1081 amd
->store
= store_save
;
1082 amd
->mem_mode
= mem_mode_save
;
1084 addr
= targetm
.delegitimize_address (addr
);
1085 if (addr
!= XEXP (mem
, 0))
1086 mem
= replace_equiv_address_nv (mem
, addr
);
1088 mem
= avoid_constant_pool_reference (mem
);
1092 size
= GET_MODE_SIZE (amd
->mem_mode
);
1093 addr
= plus_constant (GET_MODE (loc
), XEXP (loc
, 0),
1094 GET_CODE (loc
) == PRE_INC
? size
: -size
);
1099 addr
= XEXP (loc
, 0);
1100 gcc_assert (amd
->mem_mode
!= VOIDmode
&& amd
->mem_mode
!= BLKmode
);
1101 addr
= simplify_replace_fn_rtx (addr
, old_rtx
, adjust_mems
, data
);
1102 size
= GET_MODE_SIZE (amd
->mem_mode
);
1103 tem
= plus_constant (GET_MODE (loc
), XEXP (loc
, 0),
1104 (GET_CODE (loc
) == PRE_INC
1105 || GET_CODE (loc
) == POST_INC
) ? size
: -size
);
1106 store_save
= amd
->store
;
1108 tem
= simplify_replace_fn_rtx (tem
, old_rtx
, adjust_mems
, data
);
1109 amd
->store
= store_save
;
1110 amd
->side_effects
.safe_push (gen_rtx_SET (XEXP (loc
, 0), tem
));
1113 addr
= XEXP (loc
, 1);
1117 addr
= XEXP (loc
, 0);
1118 gcc_assert (amd
->mem_mode
!= VOIDmode
);
1119 addr
= simplify_replace_fn_rtx (addr
, old_rtx
, adjust_mems
, data
);
1120 store_save
= amd
->store
;
1122 tem
= simplify_replace_fn_rtx (XEXP (loc
, 1), old_rtx
,
1124 amd
->store
= store_save
;
1125 amd
->side_effects
.safe_push (gen_rtx_SET (XEXP (loc
, 0), tem
));
1128 /* First try without delegitimization of whole MEMs and
1129 avoid_constant_pool_reference, which is more likely to succeed. */
1130 store_save
= amd
->store
;
1132 addr
= simplify_replace_fn_rtx (SUBREG_REG (loc
), old_rtx
, adjust_mems
,
1134 amd
->store
= store_save
;
1135 mem
= simplify_replace_fn_rtx (addr
, old_rtx
, adjust_mems
, data
);
1136 if (mem
== SUBREG_REG (loc
))
1141 tem
= simplify_gen_subreg (GET_MODE (loc
), mem
,
1142 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (loc
)),
1146 tem
= simplify_gen_subreg (GET_MODE (loc
), addr
,
1147 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (loc
)),
1149 if (tem
== NULL_RTX
)
1150 tem
= gen_rtx_raw_SUBREG (GET_MODE (loc
), addr
, SUBREG_BYTE (loc
));
1152 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_BIND_INSNS
1153 && GET_CODE (tem
) == SUBREG
1154 && (GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (tem
)) == PLUS
1155 || GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (tem
)) == MINUS
1156 || GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (tem
)) == MULT
1157 || GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (tem
)) == ASHIFT
)
1158 && is_a
<scalar_int_mode
> (GET_MODE (tem
), &tem_mode
)
1159 && is_a
<scalar_int_mode
> (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (tem
)),
1161 && (GET_MODE_PRECISION (tem_mode
)
1162 < GET_MODE_PRECISION (tem_subreg_mode
))
1163 && subreg_lowpart_p (tem
)
1164 && use_narrower_mode_test (SUBREG_REG (tem
), tem
))
1165 return use_narrower_mode (SUBREG_REG (tem
), tem_mode
, tem_subreg_mode
);
1168 /* Don't do any replacements in second and following
1169 ASM_OPERANDS of inline-asm with multiple sets.
1170 ASM_OPERANDS_INPUT_VEC, ASM_OPERANDS_INPUT_CONSTRAINT_VEC
1171 and ASM_OPERANDS_LABEL_VEC need to be equal between
1172 all the ASM_OPERANDs in the insn and adjust_insn will
1174 if (ASM_OPERANDS_OUTPUT_IDX (loc
) != 0)
1183 /* Helper function for replacement of uses. */
1186 adjust_mem_uses (rtx
*x
, void *data
)
1188 rtx new_x
= simplify_replace_fn_rtx (*x
, NULL_RTX
, adjust_mems
, data
);
1190 validate_change (NULL_RTX
, x
, new_x
, true);
1193 /* Helper function for replacement of stores. */
1196 adjust_mem_stores (rtx loc
, const_rtx expr
, void *data
)
1200 rtx new_dest
= simplify_replace_fn_rtx (SET_DEST (expr
), NULL_RTX
,
1202 if (new_dest
!= SET_DEST (expr
))
1204 rtx xexpr
= CONST_CAST_RTX (expr
);
1205 validate_change (NULL_RTX
, &SET_DEST (xexpr
), new_dest
, true);
1210 /* Simplify INSN. Remove all {PRE,POST}_{INC,DEC,MODIFY} rtxes,
1211 replace them with their value in the insn and add the side-effects
1212 as other sets to the insn. */
1215 adjust_insn (basic_block bb
, rtx_insn
*insn
)
1219 #ifdef HAVE_window_save
1220 /* If the target machine has an explicit window save instruction, the
1221 transformation OUTGOING_REGNO -> INCOMING_REGNO is done there. */
1222 if (RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn
)
1223 && find_reg_note (insn
, REG_CFA_WINDOW_SAVE
, NULL_RTX
))
1225 unsigned int i
, nregs
= vec_safe_length (windowed_parm_regs
);
1226 rtx rtl
= gen_rtx_PARALLEL (VOIDmode
, rtvec_alloc (nregs
* 2));
1229 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (windowed_parm_regs
, i
, p
)
1231 XVECEXP (rtl
, 0, i
* 2)
1232 = gen_rtx_SET (p
->incoming
, p
->outgoing
);
1233 /* Do not clobber the attached DECL, but only the REG. */
1234 XVECEXP (rtl
, 0, i
* 2 + 1)
1235 = gen_rtx_CLOBBER (GET_MODE (p
->outgoing
),
1236 gen_raw_REG (GET_MODE (p
->outgoing
),
1237 REGNO (p
->outgoing
)));
1240 validate_change (NULL_RTX
, &PATTERN (insn
), rtl
, true);
1245 adjust_mem_data amd
;
1246 amd
.mem_mode
= VOIDmode
;
1247 amd
.stack_adjust
= -VTI (bb
)->out
.stack_adjust
;
1250 note_stores (insn
, adjust_mem_stores
, &amd
);
1253 if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn
)) == PARALLEL
1254 && asm_noperands (PATTERN (insn
)) > 0
1255 && GET_CODE (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn
), 0, 0)) == SET
)
1260 /* inline-asm with multiple sets is tiny bit more complicated,
1261 because the 3 vectors in ASM_OPERANDS need to be shared between
1262 all ASM_OPERANDS in the instruction. adjust_mems will
1263 not touch ASM_OPERANDS other than the first one, asm_noperands
1264 test above needs to be called before that (otherwise it would fail)
1265 and afterwards this code fixes it up. */
1266 note_uses (&PATTERN (insn
), adjust_mem_uses
, &amd
);
1267 body
= PATTERN (insn
);
1268 set0
= XVECEXP (body
, 0, 0);
1269 gcc_checking_assert (GET_CODE (set0
) == SET
1270 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set0
)) == ASM_OPERANDS
1271 && ASM_OPERANDS_OUTPUT_IDX (SET_SRC (set0
)) == 0);
1272 for (i
= 1; i
< XVECLEN (body
, 0); i
++)
1273 if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (body
, 0, i
)) != SET
)
1277 set
= XVECEXP (body
, 0, i
);
1278 gcc_checking_assert (GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set
)) == ASM_OPERANDS
1279 && ASM_OPERANDS_OUTPUT_IDX (SET_SRC (set
))
1281 if (ASM_OPERANDS_INPUT_VEC (SET_SRC (set
))
1282 != ASM_OPERANDS_INPUT_VEC (SET_SRC (set0
))
1283 || ASM_OPERANDS_INPUT_CONSTRAINT_VEC (SET_SRC (set
))
1284 != ASM_OPERANDS_INPUT_CONSTRAINT_VEC (SET_SRC (set0
))
1285 || ASM_OPERANDS_LABEL_VEC (SET_SRC (set
))
1286 != ASM_OPERANDS_LABEL_VEC (SET_SRC (set0
)))
1288 rtx newsrc
= shallow_copy_rtx (SET_SRC (set
));
1289 ASM_OPERANDS_INPUT_VEC (newsrc
)
1290 = ASM_OPERANDS_INPUT_VEC (SET_SRC (set0
));
1291 ASM_OPERANDS_INPUT_CONSTRAINT_VEC (newsrc
)
1292 = ASM_OPERANDS_INPUT_CONSTRAINT_VEC (SET_SRC (set0
));
1293 ASM_OPERANDS_LABEL_VEC (newsrc
)
1294 = ASM_OPERANDS_LABEL_VEC (SET_SRC (set0
));
1295 validate_change (NULL_RTX
, &SET_SRC (set
), newsrc
, true);
1300 note_uses (&PATTERN (insn
), adjust_mem_uses
, &amd
);
1302 /* For read-only MEMs containing some constant, prefer those
1304 set
= single_set (insn
);
1305 if (set
&& MEM_P (SET_SRC (set
)) && MEM_READONLY_P (SET_SRC (set
)))
1307 rtx note
= find_reg_equal_equiv_note (insn
);
1309 if (note
&& CONSTANT_P (XEXP (note
, 0)))
1310 validate_change (NULL_RTX
, &SET_SRC (set
), XEXP (note
, 0), true);
1313 if (!amd
.side_effects
.is_empty ())
1318 pat
= &PATTERN (insn
);
1319 if (GET_CODE (*pat
) == COND_EXEC
)
1320 pat
= &COND_EXEC_CODE (*pat
);
1321 if (GET_CODE (*pat
) == PARALLEL
)
1322 oldn
= XVECLEN (*pat
, 0);
1325 unsigned int newn
= amd
.side_effects
.length ();
1326 new_pat
= gen_rtx_PARALLEL (VOIDmode
, rtvec_alloc (oldn
+ newn
));
1327 if (GET_CODE (*pat
) == PARALLEL
)
1328 for (i
= 0; i
< oldn
; i
++)
1329 XVECEXP (new_pat
, 0, i
) = XVECEXP (*pat
, 0, i
);
1331 XVECEXP (new_pat
, 0, 0) = *pat
;
1335 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT_REVERSE (amd
.side_effects
, j
, effect
)
1336 XVECEXP (new_pat
, 0, j
+ oldn
) = effect
;
1337 validate_change (NULL_RTX
, pat
, new_pat
, true);
1341 /* Return the DEBUG_EXPR of a DEBUG_EXPR_DECL or the VALUE in DV. */
1343 dv_as_rtx (decl_or_value dv
)
1347 if (dv_is_value_p (dv
))
1348 return dv_as_value (dv
);
1350 decl
= dv_as_decl (dv
);
1352 gcc_checking_assert (TREE_CODE (decl
) == DEBUG_EXPR_DECL
);
1353 return DECL_RTL_KNOWN_SET (decl
);
1356 /* Return nonzero if a decl_or_value must not have more than one
1357 variable part. The returned value discriminates among various
1358 kinds of one-part DVs ccording to enum onepart_enum. */
1359 static inline onepart_enum
1360 dv_onepart_p (decl_or_value dv
)
1364 if (!MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_BIND_INSNS
)
1367 if (dv_is_value_p (dv
))
1368 return ONEPART_VALUE
;
1370 decl
= dv_as_decl (dv
);
1372 if (TREE_CODE (decl
) == DEBUG_EXPR_DECL
)
1373 return ONEPART_DEXPR
;
1375 if (target_for_debug_bind (decl
) != NULL_TREE
)
1376 return ONEPART_VDECL
;
1381 /* Return the variable pool to be used for a dv of type ONEPART. */
1382 static inline pool_allocator
&
1383 onepart_pool (onepart_enum onepart
)
1385 return onepart
? valvar_pool
: var_pool
;
1388 /* Allocate a variable_def from the corresponding variable pool. */
1389 static inline variable
*
1390 onepart_pool_allocate (onepart_enum onepart
)
1392 return (variable
*) onepart_pool (onepart
).allocate ();
1395 /* Build a decl_or_value out of a decl. */
1396 static inline decl_or_value
1397 dv_from_decl (tree decl
)
1401 gcc_checking_assert (dv_is_decl_p (dv
));
1405 /* Build a decl_or_value out of a value. */
1406 static inline decl_or_value
1407 dv_from_value (rtx value
)
1411 gcc_checking_assert (dv_is_value_p (dv
));
1415 /* Return a value or the decl of a debug_expr as a decl_or_value. */
1416 static inline decl_or_value
1421 switch (GET_CODE (x
))
1424 dv
= dv_from_decl (DEBUG_EXPR_TREE_DECL (x
));
1425 gcc_checking_assert (DECL_RTL_KNOWN_SET (DEBUG_EXPR_TREE_DECL (x
)) == x
);
1429 dv
= dv_from_value (x
);
1439 extern void debug_dv (decl_or_value dv
);
1442 debug_dv (decl_or_value dv
)
1444 if (dv_is_value_p (dv
))
1445 debug_rtx (dv_as_value (dv
));
1447 debug_generic_stmt (dv_as_decl (dv
));
1450 static void loc_exp_dep_clear (variable
*var
);
1452 /* Free the element of VARIABLE_HTAB (its type is struct variable_def). */
1455 variable_htab_free (void *elem
)
1458 variable
*var
= (variable
*) elem
;
1459 location_chain
*node
, *next
;
1461 gcc_checking_assert (var
->refcount
> 0);
1464 if (var
->refcount
> 0)
1467 for (i
= 0; i
< var
->n_var_parts
; i
++)
1469 for (node
= var
->var_part
[i
].loc_chain
; node
; node
= next
)
1474 var
->var_part
[i
].loc_chain
= NULL
;
1476 if (var
->onepart
&& VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
))
1478 loc_exp_dep_clear (var
);
1479 if (VAR_LOC_DEP_LST (var
))
1480 VAR_LOC_DEP_LST (var
)->pprev
= NULL
;
1481 XDELETE (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
));
1482 /* These may be reused across functions, so reset
1484 if (var
->onepart
== ONEPART_DEXPR
)
1485 set_dv_changed (var
->dv
, true);
1487 onepart_pool (var
->onepart
).remove (var
);
1490 /* Initialize the set (array) SET of attrs to empty lists. */
1493 init_attrs_list_set (attrs
**set
)
1497 for (i
= 0; i
< FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
; i
++)
1501 /* Make the list *LISTP empty. */
1504 attrs_list_clear (attrs
**listp
)
1508 for (list
= *listp
; list
; list
= next
)
1516 /* Return true if the pair of DECL and OFFSET is the member of the LIST. */
1519 attrs_list_member (attrs
*list
, decl_or_value dv
, HOST_WIDE_INT offset
)
1521 for (; list
; list
= list
->next
)
1522 if (dv_as_opaque (list
->dv
) == dv_as_opaque (dv
) && list
->offset
== offset
)
1527 /* Insert the triplet DECL, OFFSET, LOC to the list *LISTP. */
1530 attrs_list_insert (attrs
**listp
, decl_or_value dv
,
1531 HOST_WIDE_INT offset
, rtx loc
)
1533 attrs
*list
= new attrs
;
1536 list
->offset
= offset
;
1537 list
->next
= *listp
;
1541 /* Copy all nodes from SRC and create a list *DSTP of the copies. */
1544 attrs_list_copy (attrs
**dstp
, attrs
*src
)
1546 attrs_list_clear (dstp
);
1547 for (; src
; src
= src
->next
)
1549 attrs
*n
= new attrs
;
1552 n
->offset
= src
->offset
;
1558 /* Add all nodes from SRC which are not in *DSTP to *DSTP. */
1561 attrs_list_union (attrs
**dstp
, attrs
*src
)
1563 for (; src
; src
= src
->next
)
1565 if (!attrs_list_member (*dstp
, src
->dv
, src
->offset
))
1566 attrs_list_insert (dstp
, src
->dv
, src
->offset
, src
->loc
);
1570 /* Combine nodes that are not onepart nodes from SRC and SRC2 into
1574 attrs_list_mpdv_union (attrs
**dstp
, attrs
*src
, attrs
*src2
)
1576 gcc_assert (!*dstp
);
1577 for (; src
; src
= src
->next
)
1579 if (!dv_onepart_p (src
->dv
))
1580 attrs_list_insert (dstp
, src
->dv
, src
->offset
, src
->loc
);
1582 for (src
= src2
; src
; src
= src
->next
)
1584 if (!dv_onepart_p (src
->dv
)
1585 && !attrs_list_member (*dstp
, src
->dv
, src
->offset
))
1586 attrs_list_insert (dstp
, src
->dv
, src
->offset
, src
->loc
);
1590 /* Shared hashtable support. */
1592 /* Return true if VARS is shared. */
1595 shared_hash_shared (shared_hash
*vars
)
1597 return vars
->refcount
> 1;
1600 /* Return the hash table for VARS. */
1602 static inline variable_table_type
*
1603 shared_hash_htab (shared_hash
*vars
)
1608 /* Return true if VAR is shared, or maybe because VARS is shared. */
1611 shared_var_p (variable
*var
, shared_hash
*vars
)
1613 /* Don't count an entry in the changed_variables table as a duplicate. */
1614 return ((var
->refcount
> 1 + (int) var
->in_changed_variables
)
1615 || shared_hash_shared (vars
));
1618 /* Copy variables into a new hash table. */
1620 static shared_hash
*
1621 shared_hash_unshare (shared_hash
*vars
)
1623 shared_hash
*new_vars
= new shared_hash
;
1624 gcc_assert (vars
->refcount
> 1);
1625 new_vars
->refcount
= 1;
1626 new_vars
->htab
= new variable_table_type (vars
->htab
->elements () + 3);
1627 vars_copy (new_vars
->htab
, vars
->htab
);
1632 /* Increment reference counter on VARS and return it. */
1634 static inline shared_hash
*
1635 shared_hash_copy (shared_hash
*vars
)
1641 /* Decrement reference counter and destroy hash table if not shared
1645 shared_hash_destroy (shared_hash
*vars
)
1647 gcc_checking_assert (vars
->refcount
> 0);
1648 if (--vars
->refcount
== 0)
1655 /* Unshare *PVARS if shared and return slot for DV. If INS is
1656 INSERT, insert it if not already present. */
1658 static inline variable
**
1659 shared_hash_find_slot_unshare_1 (shared_hash
**pvars
, decl_or_value dv
,
1660 hashval_t dvhash
, enum insert_option ins
)
1662 if (shared_hash_shared (*pvars
))
1663 *pvars
= shared_hash_unshare (*pvars
);
1664 return shared_hash_htab (*pvars
)->find_slot_with_hash (dv
, dvhash
, ins
);
1667 static inline variable
**
1668 shared_hash_find_slot_unshare (shared_hash
**pvars
, decl_or_value dv
,
1669 enum insert_option ins
)
1671 return shared_hash_find_slot_unshare_1 (pvars
, dv
, dv_htab_hash (dv
), ins
);
1674 /* Return slot for DV, if it is already present in the hash table.
1675 If it is not present, insert it only VARS is not shared, otherwise
1678 static inline variable
**
1679 shared_hash_find_slot_1 (shared_hash
*vars
, decl_or_value dv
, hashval_t dvhash
)
1681 return shared_hash_htab (vars
)->find_slot_with_hash (dv
, dvhash
,
1682 shared_hash_shared (vars
)
1683 ? NO_INSERT
: INSERT
);
1686 static inline variable
**
1687 shared_hash_find_slot (shared_hash
*vars
, decl_or_value dv
)
1689 return shared_hash_find_slot_1 (vars
, dv
, dv_htab_hash (dv
));
1692 /* Return slot for DV only if it is already present in the hash table. */
1694 static inline variable
**
1695 shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert_1 (shared_hash
*vars
, decl_or_value dv
,
1698 return shared_hash_htab (vars
)->find_slot_with_hash (dv
, dvhash
, NO_INSERT
);
1701 static inline variable
**
1702 shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert (shared_hash
*vars
, decl_or_value dv
)
1704 return shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert_1 (vars
, dv
, dv_htab_hash (dv
));
1707 /* Return variable for DV or NULL if not already present in the hash
1710 static inline variable
*
1711 shared_hash_find_1 (shared_hash
*vars
, decl_or_value dv
, hashval_t dvhash
)
1713 return shared_hash_htab (vars
)->find_with_hash (dv
, dvhash
);
1716 static inline variable
*
1717 shared_hash_find (shared_hash
*vars
, decl_or_value dv
)
1719 return shared_hash_find_1 (vars
, dv
, dv_htab_hash (dv
));
1722 /* Return true if TVAL is better than CVAL as a canonival value. We
1723 choose lowest-numbered VALUEs, using the RTX address as a
1724 tie-breaker. The idea is to arrange them into a star topology,
1725 such that all of them are at most one step away from the canonical
1726 value, and the canonical value has backlinks to all of them, in
1727 addition to all the actual locations. We don't enforce this
1728 topology throughout the entire dataflow analysis, though.
1732 canon_value_cmp (rtx tval
, rtx cval
)
1735 || CSELIB_VAL_PTR (tval
)->uid
< CSELIB_VAL_PTR (cval
)->uid
;
1738 static bool dst_can_be_shared
;
1740 /* Return a copy of a variable VAR and insert it to dataflow set SET. */
1743 unshare_variable (dataflow_set
*set
, variable
**slot
, variable
*var
,
1744 enum var_init_status initialized
)
1749 new_var
= onepart_pool_allocate (var
->onepart
);
1750 new_var
->dv
= var
->dv
;
1751 new_var
->refcount
= 1;
1753 new_var
->n_var_parts
= var
->n_var_parts
;
1754 new_var
->onepart
= var
->onepart
;
1755 new_var
->in_changed_variables
= false;
1757 if (! flag_var_tracking_uninit
)
1758 initialized
= VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
;
1760 for (i
= 0; i
< var
->n_var_parts
; i
++)
1762 location_chain
*node
;
1763 location_chain
**nextp
;
1765 if (i
== 0 && var
->onepart
)
1767 /* One-part auxiliary data is only used while emitting
1768 notes, so propagate it to the new variable in the active
1769 dataflow set. If we're not emitting notes, this will be
1771 gcc_checking_assert (!VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
) || emit_notes
);
1772 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (new_var
) = VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
);
1773 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
) = NULL
;
1776 VAR_PART_OFFSET (new_var
, i
) = VAR_PART_OFFSET (var
, i
);
1777 nextp
= &new_var
->var_part
[i
].loc_chain
;
1778 for (node
= var
->var_part
[i
].loc_chain
; node
; node
= node
->next
)
1780 location_chain
*new_lc
;
1782 new_lc
= new location_chain
;
1783 new_lc
->next
= NULL
;
1784 if (node
->init
> initialized
)
1785 new_lc
->init
= node
->init
;
1787 new_lc
->init
= initialized
;
1788 if (node
->set_src
&& !(MEM_P (node
->set_src
)))
1789 new_lc
->set_src
= node
->set_src
;
1791 new_lc
->set_src
= NULL
;
1792 new_lc
->loc
= node
->loc
;
1795 nextp
= &new_lc
->next
;
1798 new_var
->var_part
[i
].cur_loc
= var
->var_part
[i
].cur_loc
;
1801 dst_can_be_shared
= false;
1802 if (shared_hash_shared (set
->vars
))
1803 slot
= shared_hash_find_slot_unshare (&set
->vars
, var
->dv
, NO_INSERT
);
1804 else if (set
->traversed_vars
&& set
->vars
!= set
->traversed_vars
)
1805 slot
= shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert (set
->vars
, var
->dv
);
1807 if (var
->in_changed_variables
)
1810 = changed_variables
->find_slot_with_hash (var
->dv
,
1811 dv_htab_hash (var
->dv
),
1813 gcc_assert (*cslot
== (void *) var
);
1814 var
->in_changed_variables
= false;
1815 variable_htab_free (var
);
1817 new_var
->in_changed_variables
= true;
1822 /* Copy all variables from hash table SRC to hash table DST. */
1825 vars_copy (variable_table_type
*dst
, variable_table_type
*src
)
1827 variable_iterator_type hi
;
1830 FOR_EACH_HASH_TABLE_ELEMENT (*src
, var
, variable
, hi
)
1834 dstp
= dst
->find_slot_with_hash (var
->dv
, dv_htab_hash (var
->dv
),
1840 /* Map a decl to its main debug decl. */
1843 var_debug_decl (tree decl
)
1845 if (decl
&& VAR_P (decl
) && DECL_HAS_DEBUG_EXPR_P (decl
))
1847 tree debugdecl
= DECL_DEBUG_EXPR (decl
);
1848 if (DECL_P (debugdecl
))
1855 /* Set the register LOC to contain DV, OFFSET. */
1858 var_reg_decl_set (dataflow_set
*set
, rtx loc
, enum var_init_status initialized
,
1859 decl_or_value dv
, HOST_WIDE_INT offset
, rtx set_src
,
1860 enum insert_option iopt
)
1863 bool decl_p
= dv_is_decl_p (dv
);
1866 dv
= dv_from_decl (var_debug_decl (dv_as_decl (dv
)));
1868 for (node
= set
->regs
[REGNO (loc
)]; node
; node
= node
->next
)
1869 if (dv_as_opaque (node
->dv
) == dv_as_opaque (dv
)
1870 && node
->offset
== offset
)
1873 attrs_list_insert (&set
->regs
[REGNO (loc
)], dv
, offset
, loc
);
1874 set_variable_part (set
, loc
, dv
, offset
, initialized
, set_src
, iopt
);
1877 /* Return true if we should track a location that is OFFSET bytes from
1878 a variable. Store the constant offset in *OFFSET_OUT if so. */
1881 track_offset_p (poly_int64 offset
, HOST_WIDE_INT
*offset_out
)
1883 HOST_WIDE_INT const_offset
;
1884 if (!offset
.is_constant (&const_offset
)
1885 || !IN_RANGE (const_offset
, 0, MAX_VAR_PARTS
- 1))
1887 *offset_out
= const_offset
;
1891 /* Return the offset of a register that track_offset_p says we
1894 static HOST_WIDE_INT
1895 get_tracked_reg_offset (rtx loc
)
1897 HOST_WIDE_INT offset
;
1898 if (!track_offset_p (REG_OFFSET (loc
), &offset
))
1903 /* Set the register to contain REG_EXPR (LOC), REG_OFFSET (LOC). */
1906 var_reg_set (dataflow_set
*set
, rtx loc
, enum var_init_status initialized
,
1909 tree decl
= REG_EXPR (loc
);
1910 HOST_WIDE_INT offset
= get_tracked_reg_offset (loc
);
1912 var_reg_decl_set (set
, loc
, initialized
,
1913 dv_from_decl (decl
), offset
, set_src
, INSERT
);
1916 static enum var_init_status
1917 get_init_value (dataflow_set
*set
, rtx loc
, decl_or_value dv
)
1921 enum var_init_status ret_val
= VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNKNOWN
;
1923 if (! flag_var_tracking_uninit
)
1924 return VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
;
1926 var
= shared_hash_find (set
->vars
, dv
);
1929 for (i
= 0; i
< var
->n_var_parts
&& ret_val
== VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNKNOWN
; i
++)
1931 location_chain
*nextp
;
1932 for (nextp
= var
->var_part
[i
].loc_chain
; nextp
; nextp
= nextp
->next
)
1933 if (rtx_equal_p (nextp
->loc
, loc
))
1935 ret_val
= nextp
->init
;
1944 /* Delete current content of register LOC in dataflow set SET and set
1945 the register to contain REG_EXPR (LOC), REG_OFFSET (LOC). If
1946 MODIFY is true, any other live copies of the same variable part are
1947 also deleted from the dataflow set, otherwise the variable part is
1948 assumed to be copied from another location holding the same
1952 var_reg_delete_and_set (dataflow_set
*set
, rtx loc
, bool modify
,
1953 enum var_init_status initialized
, rtx set_src
)
1955 tree decl
= REG_EXPR (loc
);
1956 HOST_WIDE_INT offset
= get_tracked_reg_offset (loc
);
1960 decl
= var_debug_decl (decl
);
1962 if (initialized
== VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNKNOWN
)
1963 initialized
= get_init_value (set
, loc
, dv_from_decl (decl
));
1965 nextp
= &set
->regs
[REGNO (loc
)];
1966 for (node
= *nextp
; node
; node
= next
)
1969 if (dv_as_opaque (node
->dv
) != decl
|| node
->offset
!= offset
)
1971 delete_variable_part (set
, node
->loc
, node
->dv
, node
->offset
);
1978 nextp
= &node
->next
;
1982 clobber_variable_part (set
, loc
, dv_from_decl (decl
), offset
, set_src
);
1983 var_reg_set (set
, loc
, initialized
, set_src
);
1986 /* Delete the association of register LOC in dataflow set SET with any
1987 variables that aren't onepart. If CLOBBER is true, also delete any
1988 other live copies of the same variable part, and delete the
1989 association with onepart dvs too. */
1992 var_reg_delete (dataflow_set
*set
, rtx loc
, bool clobber
)
1994 attrs
**nextp
= &set
->regs
[REGNO (loc
)];
1997 HOST_WIDE_INT offset
;
1998 if (clobber
&& track_offset_p (REG_OFFSET (loc
), &offset
))
2000 tree decl
= REG_EXPR (loc
);
2002 decl
= var_debug_decl (decl
);
2004 clobber_variable_part (set
, NULL
, dv_from_decl (decl
), offset
, NULL
);
2007 for (node
= *nextp
; node
; node
= next
)
2010 if (clobber
|| !dv_onepart_p (node
->dv
))
2012 delete_variable_part (set
, node
->loc
, node
->dv
, node
->offset
);
2017 nextp
= &node
->next
;
2021 /* Delete content of register with number REGNO in dataflow set SET. */
2024 var_regno_delete (dataflow_set
*set
, int regno
)
2026 attrs
**reg
= &set
->regs
[regno
];
2029 for (node
= *reg
; node
; node
= next
)
2032 delete_variable_part (set
, node
->loc
, node
->dv
, node
->offset
);
2038 /* Return true if I is the negated value of a power of two. */
2040 negative_power_of_two_p (HOST_WIDE_INT i
)
2042 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT x
= -(unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
)i
;
2043 return pow2_or_zerop (x
);
2046 /* Strip constant offsets and alignments off of LOC. Return the base
2050 vt_get_canonicalize_base (rtx loc
)
2052 while ((GET_CODE (loc
) == PLUS
2053 || GET_CODE (loc
) == AND
)
2054 && GET_CODE (XEXP (loc
, 1)) == CONST_INT
2055 && (GET_CODE (loc
) != AND
2056 || negative_power_of_two_p (INTVAL (XEXP (loc
, 1)))))
2057 loc
= XEXP (loc
, 0);
2062 /* This caches canonicalized addresses for VALUEs, computed using
2063 information in the global cselib table. */
2064 static hash_map
<rtx
, rtx
> *global_get_addr_cache
;
2066 /* This caches canonicalized addresses for VALUEs, computed using
2067 information from the global cache and information pertaining to a
2068 basic block being analyzed. */
2069 static hash_map
<rtx
, rtx
> *local_get_addr_cache
;
2071 static rtx
vt_canonicalize_addr (dataflow_set
*, rtx
);
2073 /* Return the canonical address for LOC, that must be a VALUE, using a
2074 cached global equivalence or computing it and storing it in the
2078 get_addr_from_global_cache (rtx
const loc
)
2082 gcc_checking_assert (GET_CODE (loc
) == VALUE
);
2085 rtx
*slot
= &global_get_addr_cache
->get_or_insert (loc
, &existed
);
2089 x
= canon_rtx (get_addr (loc
));
2091 /* Tentative, avoiding infinite recursion. */
2096 rtx nx
= vt_canonicalize_addr (NULL
, x
);
2099 /* The table may have moved during recursion, recompute
2101 *global_get_addr_cache
->get (loc
) = x
= nx
;
2108 /* Return the canonical address for LOC, that must be a VALUE, using a
2109 cached local equivalence or computing it and storing it in the
2113 get_addr_from_local_cache (dataflow_set
*set
, rtx
const loc
)
2120 gcc_checking_assert (GET_CODE (loc
) == VALUE
);
2123 rtx
*slot
= &local_get_addr_cache
->get_or_insert (loc
, &existed
);
2127 x
= get_addr_from_global_cache (loc
);
2129 /* Tentative, avoiding infinite recursion. */
2132 /* Recurse to cache local expansion of X, or if we need to search
2133 for a VALUE in the expansion. */
2136 rtx nx
= vt_canonicalize_addr (set
, x
);
2139 slot
= local_get_addr_cache
->get (loc
);
2145 dv
= dv_from_rtx (x
);
2146 var
= shared_hash_find (set
->vars
, dv
);
2150 /* Look for an improved equivalent expression. */
2151 for (l
= var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
; l
; l
= l
->next
)
2153 rtx base
= vt_get_canonicalize_base (l
->loc
);
2154 if (GET_CODE (base
) == VALUE
2155 && canon_value_cmp (base
, loc
))
2157 rtx nx
= vt_canonicalize_addr (set
, l
->loc
);
2160 slot
= local_get_addr_cache
->get (loc
);
2170 /* Canonicalize LOC using equivalences from SET in addition to those
2171 in the cselib static table. It expects a VALUE-based expression,
2172 and it will only substitute VALUEs with other VALUEs or
2173 function-global equivalences, so that, if two addresses have base
2174 VALUEs that are locally or globally related in ways that
2175 memrefs_conflict_p cares about, they will both canonicalize to
2176 expressions that have the same base VALUE.
2178 The use of VALUEs as canonical base addresses enables the canonical
2179 RTXs to remain unchanged globally, if they resolve to a constant,
2180 or throughout a basic block otherwise, so that they can be cached
2181 and the cache needs not be invalidated when REGs, MEMs or such
2185 vt_canonicalize_addr (dataflow_set
*set
, rtx oloc
)
2187 poly_int64 ofst
= 0, term
;
2188 machine_mode mode
= GET_MODE (oloc
);
2195 while (GET_CODE (loc
) == PLUS
2196 && poly_int_rtx_p (XEXP (loc
, 1), &term
))
2199 loc
= XEXP (loc
, 0);
2202 /* Alignment operations can't normally be combined, so just
2203 canonicalize the base and we're done. We'll normally have
2204 only one stack alignment anyway. */
2205 if (GET_CODE (loc
) == AND
2206 && GET_CODE (XEXP (loc
, 1)) == CONST_INT
2207 && negative_power_of_two_p (INTVAL (XEXP (loc
, 1))))
2209 x
= vt_canonicalize_addr (set
, XEXP (loc
, 0));
2210 if (x
!= XEXP (loc
, 0))
2211 loc
= gen_rtx_AND (mode
, x
, XEXP (loc
, 1));
2215 if (GET_CODE (loc
) == VALUE
)
2218 loc
= get_addr_from_local_cache (set
, loc
);
2220 loc
= get_addr_from_global_cache (loc
);
2222 /* Consolidate plus_constants. */
2223 while (maybe_ne (ofst
, 0)
2224 && GET_CODE (loc
) == PLUS
2225 && poly_int_rtx_p (XEXP (loc
, 1), &term
))
2228 loc
= XEXP (loc
, 0);
2235 x
= canon_rtx (loc
);
2242 /* Add OFST back in. */
2243 if (maybe_ne (ofst
, 0))
2245 /* Don't build new RTL if we can help it. */
2246 if (strip_offset (oloc
, &term
) == loc
&& known_eq (term
, ofst
))
2249 loc
= plus_constant (mode
, loc
, ofst
);
2255 /* Return true iff there's a true dependence between MLOC and LOC.
2256 MADDR must be a canonicalized version of MLOC's address. */
2259 vt_canon_true_dep (dataflow_set
*set
, rtx mloc
, rtx maddr
, rtx loc
)
2261 if (GET_CODE (loc
) != MEM
)
2264 rtx addr
= vt_canonicalize_addr (set
, XEXP (loc
, 0));
2265 if (!canon_true_dependence (mloc
, GET_MODE (mloc
), maddr
, loc
, addr
))
2271 /* Hold parameters for the hashtab traversal function
2272 drop_overlapping_mem_locs, see below. */
2274 struct overlapping_mems
2280 /* Remove all MEMs that overlap with COMS->LOC from the location list
2281 of a hash table entry for a onepart variable. COMS->ADDR must be a
2282 canonicalized form of COMS->LOC's address, and COMS->LOC must be
2283 canonicalized itself. */
2286 drop_overlapping_mem_locs (variable
**slot
, overlapping_mems
*coms
)
2288 dataflow_set
*set
= coms
->set
;
2289 rtx mloc
= coms
->loc
, addr
= coms
->addr
;
2290 variable
*var
= *slot
;
2292 if (var
->onepart
!= NOT_ONEPART
)
2294 location_chain
*loc
, **locp
;
2295 bool changed
= false;
2298 gcc_assert (var
->n_var_parts
== 1);
2300 if (shared_var_p (var
, set
->vars
))
2302 for (loc
= var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
; loc
; loc
= loc
->next
)
2303 if (vt_canon_true_dep (set
, mloc
, addr
, loc
->loc
))
2309 slot
= unshare_variable (set
, slot
, var
, VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNKNOWN
);
2311 gcc_assert (var
->n_var_parts
== 1);
2314 if (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
))
2315 cur_loc
= VAR_LOC_FROM (var
);
2317 cur_loc
= var
->var_part
[0].cur_loc
;
2319 for (locp
= &var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
, loc
= *locp
;
2322 if (!vt_canon_true_dep (set
, mloc
, addr
, loc
->loc
))
2329 /* If we have deleted the location which was last emitted
2330 we have to emit new location so add the variable to set
2331 of changed variables. */
2332 if (cur_loc
== loc
->loc
)
2335 var
->var_part
[0].cur_loc
= NULL
;
2336 if (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
))
2337 VAR_LOC_FROM (var
) = NULL
;
2342 if (!var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
)
2348 variable_was_changed (var
, set
);
2354 /* Remove from SET all VALUE bindings to MEMs that overlap with LOC. */
2357 clobber_overlapping_mems (dataflow_set
*set
, rtx loc
)
2359 struct overlapping_mems coms
;
2361 gcc_checking_assert (GET_CODE (loc
) == MEM
);
2364 coms
.loc
= canon_rtx (loc
);
2365 coms
.addr
= vt_canonicalize_addr (set
, XEXP (loc
, 0));
2367 set
->traversed_vars
= set
->vars
;
2368 shared_hash_htab (set
->vars
)
2369 ->traverse
<overlapping_mems
*, drop_overlapping_mem_locs
> (&coms
);
2370 set
->traversed_vars
= NULL
;
2373 /* Set the location of DV, OFFSET as the MEM LOC. */
2376 var_mem_decl_set (dataflow_set
*set
, rtx loc
, enum var_init_status initialized
,
2377 decl_or_value dv
, HOST_WIDE_INT offset
, rtx set_src
,
2378 enum insert_option iopt
)
2380 if (dv_is_decl_p (dv
))
2381 dv
= dv_from_decl (var_debug_decl (dv_as_decl (dv
)));
2383 set_variable_part (set
, loc
, dv
, offset
, initialized
, set_src
, iopt
);
2386 /* Set the location part of variable MEM_EXPR (LOC) in dataflow set
2388 Adjust the address first if it is stack pointer based. */
2391 var_mem_set (dataflow_set
*set
, rtx loc
, enum var_init_status initialized
,
2394 tree decl
= MEM_EXPR (loc
);
2395 HOST_WIDE_INT offset
= int_mem_offset (loc
);
2397 var_mem_decl_set (set
, loc
, initialized
,
2398 dv_from_decl (decl
), offset
, set_src
, INSERT
);
2401 /* Delete and set the location part of variable MEM_EXPR (LOC) in
2402 dataflow set SET to LOC. If MODIFY is true, any other live copies
2403 of the same variable part are also deleted from the dataflow set,
2404 otherwise the variable part is assumed to be copied from another
2405 location holding the same part.
2406 Adjust the address first if it is stack pointer based. */
2409 var_mem_delete_and_set (dataflow_set
*set
, rtx loc
, bool modify
,
2410 enum var_init_status initialized
, rtx set_src
)
2412 tree decl
= MEM_EXPR (loc
);
2413 HOST_WIDE_INT offset
= int_mem_offset (loc
);
2415 clobber_overlapping_mems (set
, loc
);
2416 decl
= var_debug_decl (decl
);
2418 if (initialized
== VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNKNOWN
)
2419 initialized
= get_init_value (set
, loc
, dv_from_decl (decl
));
2422 clobber_variable_part (set
, NULL
, dv_from_decl (decl
), offset
, set_src
);
2423 var_mem_set (set
, loc
, initialized
, set_src
);
2426 /* Delete the location part LOC from dataflow set SET. If CLOBBER is
2427 true, also delete any other live copies of the same variable part.
2428 Adjust the address first if it is stack pointer based. */
2431 var_mem_delete (dataflow_set
*set
, rtx loc
, bool clobber
)
2433 tree decl
= MEM_EXPR (loc
);
2434 HOST_WIDE_INT offset
= int_mem_offset (loc
);
2436 clobber_overlapping_mems (set
, loc
);
2437 decl
= var_debug_decl (decl
);
2439 clobber_variable_part (set
, NULL
, dv_from_decl (decl
), offset
, NULL
);
2440 delete_variable_part (set
, loc
, dv_from_decl (decl
), offset
);
2443 /* Return true if LOC should not be expanded for location expressions,
2447 unsuitable_loc (rtx loc
)
2449 switch (GET_CODE (loc
))
2462 /* Bind VAL to LOC in SET. If MODIFIED, detach LOC from any values
2466 val_bind (dataflow_set
*set
, rtx val
, rtx loc
, bool modified
)
2471 var_regno_delete (set
, REGNO (loc
));
2472 var_reg_decl_set (set
, loc
, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
,
2473 dv_from_value (val
), 0, NULL_RTX
, INSERT
);
2475 else if (MEM_P (loc
))
2477 struct elt_loc_list
*l
= CSELIB_VAL_PTR (val
)->locs
;
2480 clobber_overlapping_mems (set
, loc
);
2482 if (l
&& GET_CODE (l
->loc
) == VALUE
)
2483 l
= canonical_cselib_val (CSELIB_VAL_PTR (l
->loc
))->locs
;
2485 /* If this MEM is a global constant, we don't need it in the
2486 dynamic tables. ??? We should test this before emitting the
2487 micro-op in the first place. */
2489 if (GET_CODE (l
->loc
) == MEM
&& XEXP (l
->loc
, 0) == XEXP (loc
, 0))
2495 var_mem_decl_set (set
, loc
, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
,
2496 dv_from_value (val
), 0, NULL_RTX
, INSERT
);
2500 /* Other kinds of equivalences are necessarily static, at least
2501 so long as we do not perform substitutions while merging
2504 set_variable_part (set
, loc
, dv_from_value (val
), 0,
2505 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
, NULL_RTX
, INSERT
);
2509 /* Bind a value to a location it was just stored in. If MODIFIED
2510 holds, assume the location was modified, detaching it from any
2511 values bound to it. */
2514 val_store (dataflow_set
*set
, rtx val
, rtx loc
, rtx_insn
*insn
,
2517 cselib_val
*v
= CSELIB_VAL_PTR (val
);
2519 gcc_assert (cselib_preserved_value_p (v
));
2523 fprintf (dump_file
, "%i: ", insn
? INSN_UID (insn
) : 0);
2524 print_inline_rtx (dump_file
, loc
, 0);
2525 fprintf (dump_file
, " evaluates to ");
2526 print_inline_rtx (dump_file
, val
, 0);
2529 struct elt_loc_list
*l
;
2530 for (l
= v
->locs
; l
; l
= l
->next
)
2532 fprintf (dump_file
, "\n%i: ", INSN_UID (l
->setting_insn
));
2533 print_inline_rtx (dump_file
, l
->loc
, 0);
2536 fprintf (dump_file
, "\n");
2539 gcc_checking_assert (!unsuitable_loc (loc
));
2541 val_bind (set
, val
, loc
, modified
);
2544 /* Clear (canonical address) slots that reference X. */
2547 local_get_addr_clear_given_value (rtx
const &, rtx
*slot
, rtx x
)
2549 if (vt_get_canonicalize_base (*slot
) == x
)
2554 /* Reset this node, detaching all its equivalences. Return the slot
2555 in the variable hash table that holds dv, if there is one. */
2558 val_reset (dataflow_set
*set
, decl_or_value dv
)
2560 variable
*var
= shared_hash_find (set
->vars
, dv
) ;
2561 location_chain
*node
;
2564 if (!var
|| !var
->n_var_parts
)
2567 gcc_assert (var
->n_var_parts
== 1);
2569 if (var
->onepart
== ONEPART_VALUE
)
2571 rtx x
= dv_as_value (dv
);
2573 /* Relationships in the global cache don't change, so reset the
2574 local cache entry only. */
2575 rtx
*slot
= local_get_addr_cache
->get (x
);
2578 /* If the value resolved back to itself, odds are that other
2579 values may have cached it too. These entries now refer
2580 to the old X, so detach them too. Entries that used the
2581 old X but resolved to something else remain ok as long as
2582 that something else isn't also reset. */
2584 local_get_addr_cache
2585 ->traverse
<rtx
, local_get_addr_clear_given_value
> (x
);
2591 for (node
= var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
; node
; node
= node
->next
)
2592 if (GET_CODE (node
->loc
) == VALUE
2593 && canon_value_cmp (node
->loc
, cval
))
2596 for (node
= var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
; node
; node
= node
->next
)
2597 if (GET_CODE (node
->loc
) == VALUE
&& cval
!= node
->loc
)
2599 /* Redirect the equivalence link to the new canonical
2600 value, or simply remove it if it would point at
2603 set_variable_part (set
, cval
, dv_from_value (node
->loc
),
2604 0, node
->init
, node
->set_src
, NO_INSERT
);
2605 delete_variable_part (set
, dv_as_value (dv
),
2606 dv_from_value (node
->loc
), 0);
2611 decl_or_value cdv
= dv_from_value (cval
);
2613 /* Keep the remaining values connected, accumulating links
2614 in the canonical value. */
2615 for (node
= var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
; node
; node
= node
->next
)
2617 if (node
->loc
== cval
)
2619 else if (GET_CODE (node
->loc
) == REG
)
2620 var_reg_decl_set (set
, node
->loc
, node
->init
, cdv
, 0,
2621 node
->set_src
, NO_INSERT
);
2622 else if (GET_CODE (node
->loc
) == MEM
)
2623 var_mem_decl_set (set
, node
->loc
, node
->init
, cdv
, 0,
2624 node
->set_src
, NO_INSERT
);
2626 set_variable_part (set
, node
->loc
, cdv
, 0,
2627 node
->init
, node
->set_src
, NO_INSERT
);
2631 /* We remove this last, to make sure that the canonical value is not
2632 removed to the point of requiring reinsertion. */
2634 delete_variable_part (set
, dv_as_value (dv
), dv_from_value (cval
), 0);
2636 clobber_variable_part (set
, NULL
, dv
, 0, NULL
);
2639 /* Find the values in a given location and map the val to another
2640 value, if it is unique, or add the location as one holding the
2644 val_resolve (dataflow_set
*set
, rtx val
, rtx loc
, rtx_insn
*insn
)
2646 decl_or_value dv
= dv_from_value (val
);
2648 if (dump_file
&& (dump_flags
& TDF_DETAILS
))
2651 fprintf (dump_file
, "%i: ", INSN_UID (insn
));
2653 fprintf (dump_file
, "head: ");
2654 print_inline_rtx (dump_file
, val
, 0);
2655 fputs (" is at ", dump_file
);
2656 print_inline_rtx (dump_file
, loc
, 0);
2657 fputc ('\n', dump_file
);
2660 val_reset (set
, dv
);
2662 gcc_checking_assert (!unsuitable_loc (loc
));
2666 attrs
*node
, *found
= NULL
;
2668 for (node
= set
->regs
[REGNO (loc
)]; node
; node
= node
->next
)
2669 if (dv_is_value_p (node
->dv
)
2670 && GET_MODE (dv_as_value (node
->dv
)) == GET_MODE (loc
))
2674 /* Map incoming equivalences. ??? Wouldn't it be nice if
2675 we just started sharing the location lists? Maybe a
2676 circular list ending at the value itself or some
2678 set_variable_part (set
, dv_as_value (node
->dv
),
2679 dv_from_value (val
), node
->offset
,
2680 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
, NULL_RTX
, INSERT
);
2681 set_variable_part (set
, val
, node
->dv
, node
->offset
,
2682 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
, NULL_RTX
, INSERT
);
2685 /* If we didn't find any equivalence, we need to remember that
2686 this value is held in the named register. */
2690 /* ??? Attempt to find and merge equivalent MEMs or other
2693 val_bind (set
, val
, loc
, false);
2696 /* Initialize dataflow set SET to be empty.
2697 VARS_SIZE is the initial size of hash table VARS. */
2700 dataflow_set_init (dataflow_set
*set
)
2702 init_attrs_list_set (set
->regs
);
2703 set
->vars
= shared_hash_copy (empty_shared_hash
);
2704 set
->stack_adjust
= 0;
2705 set
->traversed_vars
= NULL
;
2708 /* Delete the contents of dataflow set SET. */
2711 dataflow_set_clear (dataflow_set
*set
)
2715 for (i
= 0; i
< FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
; i
++)
2716 attrs_list_clear (&set
->regs
[i
]);
2718 shared_hash_destroy (set
->vars
);
2719 set
->vars
= shared_hash_copy (empty_shared_hash
);
2722 /* Copy the contents of dataflow set SRC to DST. */
2725 dataflow_set_copy (dataflow_set
*dst
, dataflow_set
*src
)
2729 for (i
= 0; i
< FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
; i
++)
2730 attrs_list_copy (&dst
->regs
[i
], src
->regs
[i
]);
2732 shared_hash_destroy (dst
->vars
);
2733 dst
->vars
= shared_hash_copy (src
->vars
);
2734 dst
->stack_adjust
= src
->stack_adjust
;
2737 /* Information for merging lists of locations for a given offset of variable.
2739 struct variable_union_info
2741 /* Node of the location chain. */
2744 /* The sum of positions in the input chains. */
2747 /* The position in the chain of DST dataflow set. */
2751 /* Buffer for location list sorting and its allocated size. */
2752 static struct variable_union_info
*vui_vec
;
2753 static int vui_allocated
;
2755 /* Compare function for qsort, order the structures by POS element. */
2758 variable_union_info_cmp_pos (const void *n1
, const void *n2
)
2760 const struct variable_union_info
*const i1
=
2761 (const struct variable_union_info
*) n1
;
2762 const struct variable_union_info
*const i2
=
2763 ( const struct variable_union_info
*) n2
;
2765 if (i1
->pos
!= i2
->pos
)
2766 return i1
->pos
- i2
->pos
;
2768 return (i1
->pos_dst
- i2
->pos_dst
);
2771 /* Compute union of location parts of variable *SLOT and the same variable
2772 from hash table DATA. Compute "sorted" union of the location chains
2773 for common offsets, i.e. the locations of a variable part are sorted by
2774 a priority where the priority is the sum of the positions in the 2 chains
2775 (if a location is only in one list the position in the second list is
2776 defined to be larger than the length of the chains).
2777 When we are updating the location parts the newest location is in the
2778 beginning of the chain, so when we do the described "sorted" union
2779 we keep the newest locations in the beginning. */
2782 variable_union (variable
*src
, dataflow_set
*set
)
2788 dstp
= shared_hash_find_slot (set
->vars
, src
->dv
);
2789 if (!dstp
|| !*dstp
)
2793 dst_can_be_shared
= false;
2795 dstp
= shared_hash_find_slot_unshare (&set
->vars
, src
->dv
, INSERT
);
2799 /* Continue traversing the hash table. */
2805 gcc_assert (src
->n_var_parts
);
2806 gcc_checking_assert (src
->onepart
== dst
->onepart
);
2808 /* We can combine one-part variables very efficiently, because their
2809 entries are in canonical order. */
2812 location_chain
**nodep
, *dnode
, *snode
;
2814 gcc_assert (src
->n_var_parts
== 1
2815 && dst
->n_var_parts
== 1);
2817 snode
= src
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
;
2820 restart_onepart_unshared
:
2821 nodep
= &dst
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
;
2827 int r
= dnode
? loc_cmp (dnode
->loc
, snode
->loc
) : 1;
2831 location_chain
*nnode
;
2833 if (shared_var_p (dst
, set
->vars
))
2835 dstp
= unshare_variable (set
, dstp
, dst
,
2836 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
);
2838 goto restart_onepart_unshared
;
2841 *nodep
= nnode
= new location_chain
;
2842 nnode
->loc
= snode
->loc
;
2843 nnode
->init
= snode
->init
;
2844 if (!snode
->set_src
|| MEM_P (snode
->set_src
))
2845 nnode
->set_src
= NULL
;
2847 nnode
->set_src
= snode
->set_src
;
2848 nnode
->next
= dnode
;
2852 gcc_checking_assert (rtx_equal_p (dnode
->loc
, snode
->loc
));
2855 snode
= snode
->next
;
2857 nodep
= &dnode
->next
;
2864 gcc_checking_assert (!src
->onepart
);
2866 /* Count the number of location parts, result is K. */
2867 for (i
= 0, j
= 0, k
= 0;
2868 i
< src
->n_var_parts
&& j
< dst
->n_var_parts
; k
++)
2870 if (VAR_PART_OFFSET (src
, i
) == VAR_PART_OFFSET (dst
, j
))
2875 else if (VAR_PART_OFFSET (src
, i
) < VAR_PART_OFFSET (dst
, j
))
2880 k
+= src
->n_var_parts
- i
;
2881 k
+= dst
->n_var_parts
- j
;
2883 /* We track only variables whose size is <= MAX_VAR_PARTS bytes
2884 thus there are at most MAX_VAR_PARTS different offsets. */
2885 gcc_checking_assert (dst
->onepart
? k
== 1 : k
<= MAX_VAR_PARTS
);
2887 if (dst
->n_var_parts
!= k
&& shared_var_p (dst
, set
->vars
))
2889 dstp
= unshare_variable (set
, dstp
, dst
, VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNKNOWN
);
2893 i
= src
->n_var_parts
- 1;
2894 j
= dst
->n_var_parts
- 1;
2895 dst
->n_var_parts
= k
;
2897 for (k
--; k
>= 0; k
--)
2899 location_chain
*node
, *node2
;
2901 if (i
>= 0 && j
>= 0
2902 && VAR_PART_OFFSET (src
, i
) == VAR_PART_OFFSET (dst
, j
))
2904 /* Compute the "sorted" union of the chains, i.e. the locations which
2905 are in both chains go first, they are sorted by the sum of
2906 positions in the chains. */
2909 struct variable_union_info
*vui
;
2911 /* If DST is shared compare the location chains.
2912 If they are different we will modify the chain in DST with
2913 high probability so make a copy of DST. */
2914 if (shared_var_p (dst
, set
->vars
))
2916 for (node
= src
->var_part
[i
].loc_chain
,
2917 node2
= dst
->var_part
[j
].loc_chain
; node
&& node2
;
2918 node
= node
->next
, node2
= node2
->next
)
2920 if (!((REG_P (node2
->loc
)
2921 && REG_P (node
->loc
)
2922 && REGNO (node2
->loc
) == REGNO (node
->loc
))
2923 || rtx_equal_p (node2
->loc
, node
->loc
)))
2925 if (node2
->init
< node
->init
)
2926 node2
->init
= node
->init
;
2932 dstp
= unshare_variable (set
, dstp
, dst
,
2933 VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNKNOWN
);
2934 dst
= (variable
*)*dstp
;
2939 for (node
= src
->var_part
[i
].loc_chain
; node
; node
= node
->next
)
2942 for (node
= dst
->var_part
[j
].loc_chain
; node
; node
= node
->next
)
2947 /* The most common case, much simpler, no qsort is needed. */
2948 location_chain
*dstnode
= dst
->var_part
[j
].loc_chain
;
2949 dst
->var_part
[k
].loc_chain
= dstnode
;
2950 VAR_PART_OFFSET (dst
, k
) = VAR_PART_OFFSET (dst
, j
);
2952 for (node
= src
->var_part
[i
].loc_chain
; node
; node
= node
->next
)
2953 if (!((REG_P (dstnode
->loc
)
2954 && REG_P (node
->loc
)
2955 && REGNO (dstnode
->loc
) == REGNO (node
->loc
))
2956 || rtx_equal_p (dstnode
->loc
, node
->loc
)))
2958 location_chain
*new_node
;
2960 /* Copy the location from SRC. */
2961 new_node
= new location_chain
;
2962 new_node
->loc
= node
->loc
;
2963 new_node
->init
= node
->init
;
2964 if (!node
->set_src
|| MEM_P (node
->set_src
))
2965 new_node
->set_src
= NULL
;
2967 new_node
->set_src
= node
->set_src
;
2968 node2
->next
= new_node
;
2975 if (src_l
+ dst_l
> vui_allocated
)
2977 vui_allocated
= MAX (vui_allocated
* 2, src_l
+ dst_l
);
2978 vui_vec
= XRESIZEVEC (struct variable_union_info
, vui_vec
,
2983 /* Fill in the locations from DST. */
2984 for (node
= dst
->var_part
[j
].loc_chain
, jj
= 0; node
;
2985 node
= node
->next
, jj
++)
2988 vui
[jj
].pos_dst
= jj
;
2990 /* Pos plus value larger than a sum of 2 valid positions. */
2991 vui
[jj
].pos
= jj
+ src_l
+ dst_l
;
2994 /* Fill in the locations from SRC. */
2996 for (node
= src
->var_part
[i
].loc_chain
, ii
= 0; node
;
2997 node
= node
->next
, ii
++)
2999 /* Find location from NODE. */
3000 for (jj
= 0; jj
< dst_l
; jj
++)
3002 if ((REG_P (vui
[jj
].lc
->loc
)
3003 && REG_P (node
->loc
)
3004 && REGNO (vui
[jj
].lc
->loc
) == REGNO (node
->loc
))
3005 || rtx_equal_p (vui
[jj
].lc
->loc
, node
->loc
))
3007 vui
[jj
].pos
= jj
+ ii
;
3011 if (jj
>= dst_l
) /* The location has not been found. */
3013 location_chain
*new_node
;
3015 /* Copy the location from SRC. */
3016 new_node
= new location_chain
;
3017 new_node
->loc
= node
->loc
;
3018 new_node
->init
= node
->init
;
3019 if (!node
->set_src
|| MEM_P (node
->set_src
))
3020 new_node
->set_src
= NULL
;
3022 new_node
->set_src
= node
->set_src
;
3023 vui
[n
].lc
= new_node
;
3024 vui
[n
].pos_dst
= src_l
+ dst_l
;
3025 vui
[n
].pos
= ii
+ src_l
+ dst_l
;
3032 /* Special case still very common case. For dst_l == 2
3033 all entries dst_l ... n-1 are sorted, with for i >= dst_l
3034 vui[i].pos == i + src_l + dst_l. */
3035 if (vui
[0].pos
> vui
[1].pos
)
3037 /* Order should be 1, 0, 2... */
3038 dst
->var_part
[k
].loc_chain
= vui
[1].lc
;
3039 vui
[1].lc
->next
= vui
[0].lc
;
3042 vui
[0].lc
->next
= vui
[2].lc
;
3043 vui
[n
- 1].lc
->next
= NULL
;
3046 vui
[0].lc
->next
= NULL
;
3051 dst
->var_part
[k
].loc_chain
= vui
[0].lc
;
3052 if (n
>= 3 && vui
[2].pos
< vui
[1].pos
)
3054 /* Order should be 0, 2, 1, 3... */
3055 vui
[0].lc
->next
= vui
[2].lc
;
3056 vui
[2].lc
->next
= vui
[1].lc
;
3059 vui
[1].lc
->next
= vui
[3].lc
;
3060 vui
[n
- 1].lc
->next
= NULL
;
3063 vui
[1].lc
->next
= NULL
;
3068 /* Order should be 0, 1, 2... */
3070 vui
[n
- 1].lc
->next
= NULL
;
3073 for (; ii
< n
; ii
++)
3074 vui
[ii
- 1].lc
->next
= vui
[ii
].lc
;
3078 qsort (vui
, n
, sizeof (struct variable_union_info
),
3079 variable_union_info_cmp_pos
);
3081 /* Reconnect the nodes in sorted order. */
3082 for (ii
= 1; ii
< n
; ii
++)
3083 vui
[ii
- 1].lc
->next
= vui
[ii
].lc
;
3084 vui
[n
- 1].lc
->next
= NULL
;
3085 dst
->var_part
[k
].loc_chain
= vui
[0].lc
;
3088 VAR_PART_OFFSET (dst
, k
) = VAR_PART_OFFSET (dst
, j
);
3093 else if ((i
>= 0 && j
>= 0
3094 && VAR_PART_OFFSET (src
, i
) < VAR_PART_OFFSET (dst
, j
))
3097 dst
->var_part
[k
] = dst
->var_part
[j
];
3100 else if ((i
>= 0 && j
>= 0
3101 && VAR_PART_OFFSET (src
, i
) > VAR_PART_OFFSET (dst
, j
))
3104 location_chain
**nextp
;
3106 /* Copy the chain from SRC. */
3107 nextp
= &dst
->var_part
[k
].loc_chain
;
3108 for (node
= src
->var_part
[i
].loc_chain
; node
; node
= node
->next
)
3110 location_chain
*new_lc
;
3112 new_lc
= new location_chain
;
3113 new_lc
->next
= NULL
;
3114 new_lc
->init
= node
->init
;
3115 if (!node
->set_src
|| MEM_P (node
->set_src
))
3116 new_lc
->set_src
= NULL
;
3118 new_lc
->set_src
= node
->set_src
;
3119 new_lc
->loc
= node
->loc
;
3122 nextp
= &new_lc
->next
;
3125 VAR_PART_OFFSET (dst
, k
) = VAR_PART_OFFSET (src
, i
);
3128 dst
->var_part
[k
].cur_loc
= NULL
;
3131 if (flag_var_tracking_uninit
)
3132 for (i
= 0; i
< src
->n_var_parts
&& i
< dst
->n_var_parts
; i
++)
3134 location_chain
*node
, *node2
;
3135 for (node
= src
->var_part
[i
].loc_chain
; node
; node
= node
->next
)
3136 for (node2
= dst
->var_part
[i
].loc_chain
; node2
; node2
= node2
->next
)
3137 if (rtx_equal_p (node
->loc
, node2
->loc
))
3139 if (node
->init
> node2
->init
)
3140 node2
->init
= node
->init
;
3144 /* Continue traversing the hash table. */
3148 /* Compute union of dataflow sets SRC and DST and store it to DST. */
3151 dataflow_set_union (dataflow_set
*dst
, dataflow_set
*src
)
3155 for (i
= 0; i
< FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
; i
++)
3156 attrs_list_union (&dst
->regs
[i
], src
->regs
[i
]);
3158 if (dst
->vars
== empty_shared_hash
)
3160 shared_hash_destroy (dst
->vars
);
3161 dst
->vars
= shared_hash_copy (src
->vars
);
3165 variable_iterator_type hi
;
3168 FOR_EACH_HASH_TABLE_ELEMENT (*shared_hash_htab (src
->vars
),
3170 variable_union (var
, dst
);
3174 /* Whether the value is currently being expanded. */
3175 #define VALUE_RECURSED_INTO(x) \
3176 (RTL_FLAG_CHECK2 ("VALUE_RECURSED_INTO", (x), VALUE, DEBUG_EXPR)->used)
3178 /* Whether no expansion was found, saving useless lookups.
3179 It must only be set when VALUE_CHANGED is clear. */
3180 #define NO_LOC_P(x) \
3181 (RTL_FLAG_CHECK2 ("NO_LOC_P", (x), VALUE, DEBUG_EXPR)->return_val)
3183 /* Whether cur_loc in the value needs to be (re)computed. */
3184 #define VALUE_CHANGED(x) \
3185 (RTL_FLAG_CHECK1 ("VALUE_CHANGED", (x), VALUE)->frame_related)
3186 /* Whether cur_loc in the decl needs to be (re)computed. */
3187 #define DECL_CHANGED(x) TREE_VISITED (x)
3189 /* Record (if NEWV) that DV needs to have its cur_loc recomputed. For
3190 user DECLs, this means they're in changed_variables. Values and
3191 debug exprs may be left with this flag set if no user variable
3192 requires them to be evaluated. */
3195 set_dv_changed (decl_or_value dv
, bool newv
)
3197 switch (dv_onepart_p (dv
))
3201 NO_LOC_P (dv_as_value (dv
)) = false;
3202 VALUE_CHANGED (dv_as_value (dv
)) = newv
;
3207 NO_LOC_P (DECL_RTL_KNOWN_SET (dv_as_decl (dv
))) = false;
3211 DECL_CHANGED (dv_as_decl (dv
)) = newv
;
3216 /* Return true if DV needs to have its cur_loc recomputed. */
3219 dv_changed_p (decl_or_value dv
)
3221 return (dv_is_value_p (dv
)
3222 ? VALUE_CHANGED (dv_as_value (dv
))
3223 : DECL_CHANGED (dv_as_decl (dv
)));
3226 /* Return a location list node whose loc is rtx_equal to LOC, in the
3227 location list of a one-part variable or value VAR, or in that of
3228 any values recursively mentioned in the location lists. VARS must
3229 be in star-canonical form. */
3231 static location_chain
*
3232 find_loc_in_1pdv (rtx loc
, variable
*var
, variable_table_type
*vars
)
3234 location_chain
*node
;
3235 enum rtx_code loc_code
;
3240 gcc_checking_assert (var
->onepart
);
3242 if (!var
->n_var_parts
)
3245 gcc_checking_assert (loc
!= dv_as_opaque (var
->dv
));
3247 loc_code
= GET_CODE (loc
);
3248 for (node
= var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
; node
; node
= node
->next
)
3253 if (GET_CODE (node
->loc
) != loc_code
)
3255 if (GET_CODE (node
->loc
) != VALUE
)
3258 else if (loc
== node
->loc
)
3260 else if (loc_code
!= VALUE
)
3262 if (rtx_equal_p (loc
, node
->loc
))
3267 /* Since we're in star-canonical form, we don't need to visit
3268 non-canonical nodes: one-part variables and non-canonical
3269 values would only point back to the canonical node. */
3270 if (dv_is_value_p (var
->dv
)
3271 && !canon_value_cmp (node
->loc
, dv_as_value (var
->dv
)))
3273 /* Skip all subsequent VALUEs. */
3274 while (node
->next
&& GET_CODE (node
->next
->loc
) == VALUE
)
3277 gcc_checking_assert (!canon_value_cmp (node
->loc
,
3278 dv_as_value (var
->dv
)));
3279 if (loc
== node
->loc
)
3285 gcc_checking_assert (node
== var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
);
3286 gcc_checking_assert (!node
->next
);
3288 dv
= dv_from_value (node
->loc
);
3289 rvar
= vars
->find_with_hash (dv
, dv_htab_hash (dv
));
3290 return find_loc_in_1pdv (loc
, rvar
, vars
);
3293 /* ??? Gotta look in cselib_val locations too. */
3298 /* Hash table iteration argument passed to variable_merge. */
3301 /* The set in which the merge is to be inserted. */
3303 /* The set that we're iterating in. */
3305 /* The set that may contain the other dv we are to merge with. */
3307 /* Number of onepart dvs in src. */
3308 int src_onepart_cnt
;
3311 /* Insert LOC in *DNODE, if it's not there yet. The list must be in
3312 loc_cmp order, and it is maintained as such. */
3315 insert_into_intersection (location_chain
**nodep
, rtx loc
,
3316 enum var_init_status status
)
3318 location_chain
*node
;
3321 for (node
= *nodep
; node
; nodep
= &node
->next
, node
= *nodep
)
3322 if ((r
= loc_cmp (node
->loc
, loc
)) == 0)
3324 node
->init
= MIN (node
->init
, status
);
3330 node
= new location_chain
;
3333 node
->set_src
= NULL
;
3334 node
->init
= status
;
3335 node
->next
= *nodep
;
3339 /* Insert in DEST the intersection of the locations present in both
3340 S1NODE and S2VAR, directly or indirectly. S1NODE is from a
3341 variable in DSM->cur, whereas S2VAR is from DSM->src. dvar is in
3345 intersect_loc_chains (rtx val
, location_chain
**dest
, struct dfset_merge
*dsm
,
3346 location_chain
*s1node
, variable
*s2var
)
3348 dataflow_set
*s1set
= dsm
->cur
;
3349 dataflow_set
*s2set
= dsm
->src
;
3350 location_chain
*found
;
3354 location_chain
*s2node
;
3356 gcc_checking_assert (s2var
->onepart
);
3358 if (s2var
->n_var_parts
)
3360 s2node
= s2var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
;
3362 for (; s1node
&& s2node
;
3363 s1node
= s1node
->next
, s2node
= s2node
->next
)
3364 if (s1node
->loc
!= s2node
->loc
)
3366 else if (s1node
->loc
== val
)
3369 insert_into_intersection (dest
, s1node
->loc
,
3370 MIN (s1node
->init
, s2node
->init
));
3374 for (; s1node
; s1node
= s1node
->next
)
3376 if (s1node
->loc
== val
)
3379 if ((found
= find_loc_in_1pdv (s1node
->loc
, s2var
,
3380 shared_hash_htab (s2set
->vars
))))
3382 insert_into_intersection (dest
, s1node
->loc
,
3383 MIN (s1node
->init
, found
->init
));
3387 if (GET_CODE (s1node
->loc
) == VALUE
3388 && !VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (s1node
->loc
))
3390 decl_or_value dv
= dv_from_value (s1node
->loc
);
3391 variable
*svar
= shared_hash_find (s1set
->vars
, dv
);
3394 if (svar
->n_var_parts
== 1)
3396 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (s1node
->loc
) = true;
3397 intersect_loc_chains (val
, dest
, dsm
,
3398 svar
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
,
3400 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (s1node
->loc
) = false;
3405 /* ??? gotta look in cselib_val locations too. */
3407 /* ??? if the location is equivalent to any location in src,
3408 searched recursively
3410 add to dst the values needed to represent the equivalence
3412 telling whether locations S is equivalent to another dv's
3415 for each location D in the list
3417 if S and D satisfy rtx_equal_p, then it is present
3419 else if D is a value, recurse without cycles
3421 else if S and D have the same CODE and MODE
3423 for each operand oS and the corresponding oD
3425 if oS and oD are not equivalent, then S an D are not equivalent
3427 else if they are RTX vectors
3429 if any vector oS element is not equivalent to its respective oD,
3430 then S and D are not equivalent
3438 /* Return -1 if X should be before Y in a location list for a 1-part
3439 variable, 1 if Y should be before X, and 0 if they're equivalent
3440 and should not appear in the list. */
3443 loc_cmp (rtx x
, rtx y
)
3446 RTX_CODE code
= GET_CODE (x
);
3456 gcc_assert (GET_MODE (x
) == GET_MODE (y
));
3457 if (REGNO (x
) == REGNO (y
))
3459 else if (REGNO (x
) < REGNO (y
))
3472 gcc_assert (GET_MODE (x
) == GET_MODE (y
));
3473 return loc_cmp (XEXP (x
, 0), XEXP (y
, 0));
3479 if (GET_CODE (x
) == VALUE
)
3481 if (GET_CODE (y
) != VALUE
)
3483 /* Don't assert the modes are the same, that is true only
3484 when not recursing. (subreg:QI (value:SI 1:1) 0)
3485 and (subreg:QI (value:DI 2:2) 0) can be compared,
3486 even when the modes are different. */
3487 if (canon_value_cmp (x
, y
))
3493 if (GET_CODE (y
) == VALUE
)
3496 /* Entry value is the least preferable kind of expression. */
3497 if (GET_CODE (x
) == ENTRY_VALUE
)
3499 if (GET_CODE (y
) != ENTRY_VALUE
)
3501 gcc_assert (GET_MODE (x
) == GET_MODE (y
));
3502 return loc_cmp (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (x
), ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (y
));
3505 if (GET_CODE (y
) == ENTRY_VALUE
)
3508 if (GET_CODE (x
) == GET_CODE (y
))
3509 /* Compare operands below. */;
3510 else if (GET_CODE (x
) < GET_CODE (y
))
3515 gcc_assert (GET_MODE (x
) == GET_MODE (y
));
3517 if (GET_CODE (x
) == DEBUG_EXPR
)
3519 if (DEBUG_TEMP_UID (DEBUG_EXPR_TREE_DECL (x
))
3520 < DEBUG_TEMP_UID (DEBUG_EXPR_TREE_DECL (y
)))
3522 gcc_checking_assert (DEBUG_TEMP_UID (DEBUG_EXPR_TREE_DECL (x
))
3523 > DEBUG_TEMP_UID (DEBUG_EXPR_TREE_DECL (y
)));
3527 fmt
= GET_RTX_FORMAT (code
);
3528 for (i
= 0; i
< GET_RTX_LENGTH (code
); i
++)
3532 if (XWINT (x
, i
) == XWINT (y
, i
))
3534 else if (XWINT (x
, i
) < XWINT (y
, i
))
3541 if (XINT (x
, i
) == XINT (y
, i
))
3543 else if (XINT (x
, i
) < XINT (y
, i
))
3549 r
= compare_sizes_for_sort (SUBREG_BYTE (x
), SUBREG_BYTE (y
));
3556 /* Compare the vector length first. */
3557 if (XVECLEN (x
, i
) == XVECLEN (y
, i
))
3558 /* Compare the vectors elements. */;
3559 else if (XVECLEN (x
, i
) < XVECLEN (y
, i
))
3564 for (j
= 0; j
< XVECLEN (x
, i
); j
++)
3565 if ((r
= loc_cmp (XVECEXP (x
, i
, j
),
3566 XVECEXP (y
, i
, j
))))
3571 if ((r
= loc_cmp (XEXP (x
, i
), XEXP (y
, i
))))
3577 if (XSTR (x
, i
) == XSTR (y
, i
))
3583 if ((r
= strcmp (XSTR (x
, i
), XSTR (y
, i
))) == 0)
3591 /* These are just backpointers, so they don't matter. */
3598 /* It is believed that rtx's at this level will never
3599 contain anything but integers and other rtx's,
3600 except for within LABEL_REFs and SYMBOL_REFs. */
3604 if (CONST_WIDE_INT_P (x
))
3606 /* Compare the vector length first. */
3607 if (CONST_WIDE_INT_NUNITS (x
) >= CONST_WIDE_INT_NUNITS (y
))
3609 else if (CONST_WIDE_INT_NUNITS (x
) < CONST_WIDE_INT_NUNITS (y
))
3612 /* Compare the vectors elements. */;
3613 for (j
= CONST_WIDE_INT_NUNITS (x
) - 1; j
>= 0 ; j
--)
3615 if (CONST_WIDE_INT_ELT (x
, j
) < CONST_WIDE_INT_ELT (y
, j
))
3617 if (CONST_WIDE_INT_ELT (x
, j
) > CONST_WIDE_INT_ELT (y
, j
))
3625 /* Check the order of entries in one-part variables. */
3628 canonicalize_loc_order_check (variable
**slot
,
3629 dataflow_set
*data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
)
3631 variable
*var
= *slot
;
3632 location_chain
*node
, *next
;
3634 #ifdef ENABLE_RTL_CHECKING
3636 for (i
= 0; i
< var
->n_var_parts
; i
++)
3637 gcc_assert (var
->var_part
[0].cur_loc
== NULL
);
3638 gcc_assert (!var
->in_changed_variables
);
3644 gcc_assert (var
->n_var_parts
== 1);
3645 node
= var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
;
3648 while ((next
= node
->next
))
3650 gcc_assert (loc_cmp (node
->loc
, next
->loc
) < 0);
3657 /* Mark with VALUE_RECURSED_INTO values that have neighbors that are
3658 more likely to be chosen as canonical for an equivalence set.
3659 Ensure less likely values can reach more likely neighbors, making
3660 the connections bidirectional. */
3663 canonicalize_values_mark (variable
**slot
, dataflow_set
*set
)
3665 variable
*var
= *slot
;
3666 decl_or_value dv
= var
->dv
;
3668 location_chain
*node
;
3670 if (!dv_is_value_p (dv
))
3673 gcc_checking_assert (var
->n_var_parts
== 1);
3675 val
= dv_as_value (dv
);
3677 for (node
= var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
; node
; node
= node
->next
)
3678 if (GET_CODE (node
->loc
) == VALUE
)
3680 if (canon_value_cmp (node
->loc
, val
))
3681 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (val
) = true;
3684 decl_or_value odv
= dv_from_value (node
->loc
);
3686 oslot
= shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert (set
->vars
, odv
);
3688 set_slot_part (set
, val
, oslot
, odv
, 0,
3689 node
->init
, NULL_RTX
);
3691 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (node
->loc
) = true;
3698 /* Remove redundant entries from equivalence lists in onepart
3699 variables, canonicalizing equivalence sets into star shapes. */
3702 canonicalize_values_star (variable
**slot
, dataflow_set
*set
)
3704 variable
*var
= *slot
;
3705 decl_or_value dv
= var
->dv
;
3706 location_chain
*node
;
3716 gcc_checking_assert (var
->n_var_parts
== 1);
3718 if (dv_is_value_p (dv
))
3720 cval
= dv_as_value (dv
);
3721 if (!VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (cval
))
3723 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (cval
) = false;
3733 gcc_assert (var
->n_var_parts
== 1);
3735 for (node
= var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
; node
; node
= node
->next
)
3736 if (GET_CODE (node
->loc
) == VALUE
)
3739 if (VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (node
->loc
))
3741 if (canon_value_cmp (node
->loc
, cval
))
3750 if (!has_marks
|| dv_is_decl_p (dv
))
3753 /* Keep it marked so that we revisit it, either after visiting a
3754 child node, or after visiting a new parent that might be
3756 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (val
) = true;
3758 for (node
= var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
; node
; node
= node
->next
)
3759 if (GET_CODE (node
->loc
) == VALUE
3760 && VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (node
->loc
))
3764 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (cval
) = false;
3765 dv
= dv_from_value (cval
);
3766 slot
= shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert (set
->vars
, dv
);
3769 gcc_assert (dv_is_decl_p (var
->dv
));
3770 /* The canonical value was reset and dropped.
3772 clobber_variable_part (set
, NULL
, var
->dv
, 0, NULL
);
3776 gcc_assert (dv_is_value_p (var
->dv
));
3777 if (var
->n_var_parts
== 0)
3779 gcc_assert (var
->n_var_parts
== 1);
3783 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (val
) = false;
3788 /* Push values to the canonical one. */
3789 cdv
= dv_from_value (cval
);
3790 cslot
= shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert (set
->vars
, cdv
);
3792 for (node
= var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
; node
; node
= node
->next
)
3793 if (node
->loc
!= cval
)
3795 cslot
= set_slot_part (set
, node
->loc
, cslot
, cdv
, 0,
3796 node
->init
, NULL_RTX
);
3797 if (GET_CODE (node
->loc
) == VALUE
)
3799 decl_or_value ndv
= dv_from_value (node
->loc
);
3801 set_variable_part (set
, cval
, ndv
, 0, node
->init
, NULL_RTX
,
3804 if (canon_value_cmp (node
->loc
, val
))
3806 /* If it could have been a local minimum, it's not any more,
3807 since it's now neighbor to cval, so it may have to push
3808 to it. Conversely, if it wouldn't have prevailed over
3809 val, then whatever mark it has is fine: if it was to
3810 push, it will now push to a more canonical node, but if
3811 it wasn't, then it has already pushed any values it might
3813 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (node
->loc
) = true;
3814 /* Make sure we visit node->loc by ensuring we cval is
3816 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (cval
) = true;
3818 else if (!VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (node
->loc
))
3819 /* If we have no need to "recurse" into this node, it's
3820 already "canonicalized", so drop the link to the old
3822 clobber_variable_part (set
, cval
, ndv
, 0, NULL
);
3824 else if (GET_CODE (node
->loc
) == REG
)
3826 attrs
*list
= set
->regs
[REGNO (node
->loc
)], **listp
;
3828 /* Change an existing attribute referring to dv so that it
3829 refers to cdv, removing any duplicate this might
3830 introduce, and checking that no previous duplicates
3831 existed, all in a single pass. */
3835 if (list
->offset
== 0
3836 && (dv_as_opaque (list
->dv
) == dv_as_opaque (dv
)
3837 || dv_as_opaque (list
->dv
) == dv_as_opaque (cdv
)))
3844 if (dv_as_opaque (list
->dv
) == dv_as_opaque (dv
))
3847 for (listp
= &list
->next
; (list
= *listp
); listp
= &list
->next
)
3852 if (dv_as_opaque (list
->dv
) == dv_as_opaque (cdv
))
3854 *listp
= list
->next
;
3860 gcc_assert (dv_as_opaque (list
->dv
) != dv_as_opaque (dv
));
3863 else if (dv_as_opaque (list
->dv
) == dv_as_opaque (cdv
))
3865 for (listp
= &list
->next
; (list
= *listp
); listp
= &list
->next
)
3870 if (dv_as_opaque (list
->dv
) == dv_as_opaque (dv
))
3872 *listp
= list
->next
;
3878 gcc_assert (dv_as_opaque (list
->dv
) != dv_as_opaque (cdv
));
3887 if (list
->offset
== 0
3888 && (dv_as_opaque (list
->dv
) == dv_as_opaque (dv
)
3889 || dv_as_opaque (list
->dv
) == dv_as_opaque (cdv
)))
3898 set_slot_part (set
, val
, cslot
, cdv
, 0,
3899 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
, NULL_RTX
);
3901 slot
= clobber_slot_part (set
, cval
, slot
, 0, NULL
);
3903 /* Variable may have been unshared. */
3905 gcc_checking_assert (var
->n_var_parts
&& var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
->loc
== cval
3906 && var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
->next
== NULL
);
3908 if (VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (cval
))
3909 goto restart_with_cval
;
3914 /* Bind one-part variables to the canonical value in an equivalence
3915 set. Not doing this causes dataflow convergence failure in rare
3916 circumstances, see PR42873. Unfortunately we can't do this
3917 efficiently as part of canonicalize_values_star, since we may not
3918 have determined or even seen the canonical value of a set when we
3919 get to a variable that references another member of the set. */
3922 canonicalize_vars_star (variable
**slot
, dataflow_set
*set
)
3924 variable
*var
= *slot
;
3925 decl_or_value dv
= var
->dv
;
3926 location_chain
*node
;
3931 location_chain
*cnode
;
3933 if (!var
->onepart
|| var
->onepart
== ONEPART_VALUE
)
3936 gcc_assert (var
->n_var_parts
== 1);
3938 node
= var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
;
3940 if (GET_CODE (node
->loc
) != VALUE
)
3943 gcc_assert (!node
->next
);
3946 /* Push values to the canonical one. */
3947 cdv
= dv_from_value (cval
);
3948 cslot
= shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert (set
->vars
, cdv
);
3952 gcc_assert (cvar
->n_var_parts
== 1);
3954 cnode
= cvar
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
;
3956 /* CVAL is canonical if its value list contains non-VALUEs or VALUEs
3957 that are not “more canonical” than it. */
3958 if (GET_CODE (cnode
->loc
) != VALUE
3959 || !canon_value_cmp (cnode
->loc
, cval
))
3962 /* CVAL was found to be non-canonical. Change the variable to point
3963 to the canonical VALUE. */
3964 gcc_assert (!cnode
->next
);
3967 slot
= set_slot_part (set
, cval
, slot
, dv
, 0,
3968 node
->init
, node
->set_src
);
3969 clobber_slot_part (set
, cval
, slot
, 0, node
->set_src
);
3974 /* Combine variable or value in *S1SLOT (in DSM->cur) with the
3975 corresponding entry in DSM->src. Multi-part variables are combined
3976 with variable_union, whereas onepart dvs are combined with
3980 variable_merge_over_cur (variable
*s1var
, struct dfset_merge
*dsm
)
3982 dataflow_set
*dst
= dsm
->dst
;
3984 variable
*s2var
, *dvar
= NULL
;
3985 decl_or_value dv
= s1var
->dv
;
3986 onepart_enum onepart
= s1var
->onepart
;
3989 location_chain
*node
, **nodep
;
3991 /* If the incoming onepart variable has an empty location list, then
3992 the intersection will be just as empty. For other variables,
3993 it's always union. */
3994 gcc_checking_assert (s1var
->n_var_parts
3995 && s1var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
);
3998 return variable_union (s1var
, dst
);
4000 gcc_checking_assert (s1var
->n_var_parts
== 1);
4002 dvhash
= dv_htab_hash (dv
);
4003 if (dv_is_value_p (dv
))
4004 val
= dv_as_value (dv
);
4008 s2var
= shared_hash_find_1 (dsm
->src
->vars
, dv
, dvhash
);
4011 dst_can_be_shared
= false;
4015 dsm
->src_onepart_cnt
--;
4016 gcc_assert (s2var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
4017 && s2var
->onepart
== onepart
4018 && s2var
->n_var_parts
== 1);
4020 dstslot
= shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert_1 (dst
->vars
, dv
, dvhash
);
4024 gcc_assert (dvar
->refcount
== 1
4025 && dvar
->onepart
== onepart
4026 && dvar
->n_var_parts
== 1);
4027 nodep
= &dvar
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
;
4035 if (!dstslot
&& !onepart_variable_different_p (s1var
, s2var
))
4037 dstslot
= shared_hash_find_slot_unshare_1 (&dst
->vars
, dv
,
4039 *dstslot
= dvar
= s2var
;
4044 dst_can_be_shared
= false;
4046 intersect_loc_chains (val
, nodep
, dsm
,
4047 s1var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
, s2var
);
4053 dvar
= onepart_pool_allocate (onepart
);
4056 dvar
->n_var_parts
= 1;
4057 dvar
->onepart
= onepart
;
4058 dvar
->in_changed_variables
= false;
4059 dvar
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
= node
;
4060 dvar
->var_part
[0].cur_loc
= NULL
;
4062 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (dvar
) = NULL
;
4064 VAR_PART_OFFSET (dvar
, 0) = 0;
4067 = shared_hash_find_slot_unshare_1 (&dst
->vars
, dv
, dvhash
,
4069 gcc_assert (!*dstslot
);
4077 nodep
= &dvar
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
;
4078 while ((node
= *nodep
))
4080 location_chain
**nextp
= &node
->next
;
4082 if (GET_CODE (node
->loc
) == REG
)
4086 for (list
= dst
->regs
[REGNO (node
->loc
)]; list
; list
= list
->next
)
4087 if (GET_MODE (node
->loc
) == GET_MODE (list
->loc
)
4088 && dv_is_value_p (list
->dv
))
4092 attrs_list_insert (&dst
->regs
[REGNO (node
->loc
)],
4094 /* If this value became canonical for another value that had
4095 this register, we want to leave it alone. */
4096 else if (dv_as_value (list
->dv
) != val
)
4098 dstslot
= set_slot_part (dst
, dv_as_value (list
->dv
),
4100 node
->init
, NULL_RTX
);
4101 dstslot
= delete_slot_part (dst
, node
->loc
, dstslot
, 0);
4103 /* Since nextp points into the removed node, we can't
4104 use it. The pointer to the next node moved to nodep.
4105 However, if the variable we're walking is unshared
4106 during our walk, we'll keep walking the location list
4107 of the previously-shared variable, in which case the
4108 node won't have been removed, and we'll want to skip
4109 it. That's why we test *nodep here. */
4115 /* Canonicalization puts registers first, so we don't have to
4121 if (dvar
!= *dstslot
)
4123 nodep
= &dvar
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
;
4127 /* Mark all referenced nodes for canonicalization, and make sure
4128 we have mutual equivalence links. */
4129 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (val
) = true;
4130 for (node
= *nodep
; node
; node
= node
->next
)
4131 if (GET_CODE (node
->loc
) == VALUE
)
4133 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (node
->loc
) = true;
4134 set_variable_part (dst
, val
, dv_from_value (node
->loc
), 0,
4135 node
->init
, NULL
, INSERT
);
4138 dstslot
= shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert_1 (dst
->vars
, dv
, dvhash
);
4139 gcc_assert (*dstslot
== dvar
);
4140 canonicalize_values_star (dstslot
, dst
);
4141 gcc_checking_assert (dstslot
4142 == shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert_1 (dst
->vars
,
4148 bool has_value
= false, has_other
= false;
4150 /* If we have one value and anything else, we're going to
4151 canonicalize this, so make sure all values have an entry in
4152 the table and are marked for canonicalization. */
4153 for (node
= *nodep
; node
; node
= node
->next
)
4155 if (GET_CODE (node
->loc
) == VALUE
)
4157 /* If this was marked during register canonicalization,
4158 we know we have to canonicalize values. */
4173 if (has_value
&& has_other
)
4175 for (node
= *nodep
; node
; node
= node
->next
)
4177 if (GET_CODE (node
->loc
) == VALUE
)
4179 decl_or_value dv
= dv_from_value (node
->loc
);
4180 variable
**slot
= NULL
;
4182 if (shared_hash_shared (dst
->vars
))
4183 slot
= shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert (dst
->vars
, dv
);
4185 slot
= shared_hash_find_slot_unshare (&dst
->vars
, dv
,
4189 variable
*var
= onepart_pool_allocate (ONEPART_VALUE
);
4192 var
->n_var_parts
= 1;
4193 var
->onepart
= ONEPART_VALUE
;
4194 var
->in_changed_variables
= false;
4195 var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
= NULL
;
4196 var
->var_part
[0].cur_loc
= NULL
;
4197 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
) = NULL
;
4201 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (node
->loc
) = true;
4205 dstslot
= shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert_1 (dst
->vars
, dv
, dvhash
);
4206 gcc_assert (*dstslot
== dvar
);
4207 canonicalize_values_star (dstslot
, dst
);
4208 gcc_checking_assert (dstslot
4209 == shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert_1 (dst
->vars
,
4215 if (!onepart_variable_different_p (dvar
, s2var
))
4217 variable_htab_free (dvar
);
4218 *dstslot
= dvar
= s2var
;
4221 else if (s2var
!= s1var
&& !onepart_variable_different_p (dvar
, s1var
))
4223 variable_htab_free (dvar
);
4224 *dstslot
= dvar
= s1var
;
4226 dst_can_be_shared
= false;
4229 dst_can_be_shared
= false;
4234 /* Copy s2slot (in DSM->src) to DSM->dst if the variable is a
4235 multi-part variable. Unions of multi-part variables and
4236 intersections of one-part ones will be handled in
4237 variable_merge_over_cur(). */
4240 variable_merge_over_src (variable
*s2var
, struct dfset_merge
*dsm
)
4242 dataflow_set
*dst
= dsm
->dst
;
4243 decl_or_value dv
= s2var
->dv
;
4245 if (!s2var
->onepart
)
4247 variable
**dstp
= shared_hash_find_slot (dst
->vars
, dv
);
4253 dsm
->src_onepart_cnt
++;
4257 /* Combine dataflow set information from SRC2 into DST, using PDST
4258 to carry over information across passes. */
4261 dataflow_set_merge (dataflow_set
*dst
, dataflow_set
*src2
)
4263 dataflow_set cur
= *dst
;
4264 dataflow_set
*src1
= &cur
;
4265 struct dfset_merge dsm
;
4267 size_t src1_elems
, src2_elems
;
4268 variable_iterator_type hi
;
4271 src1_elems
= shared_hash_htab (src1
->vars
)->elements ();
4272 src2_elems
= shared_hash_htab (src2
->vars
)->elements ();
4273 dataflow_set_init (dst
);
4274 dst
->stack_adjust
= cur
.stack_adjust
;
4275 shared_hash_destroy (dst
->vars
);
4276 dst
->vars
= new shared_hash
;
4277 dst
->vars
->refcount
= 1;
4278 dst
->vars
->htab
= new variable_table_type (MAX (src1_elems
, src2_elems
));
4280 for (i
= 0; i
< FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
; i
++)
4281 attrs_list_mpdv_union (&dst
->regs
[i
], src1
->regs
[i
], src2
->regs
[i
]);
4286 dsm
.src_onepart_cnt
= 0;
4288 FOR_EACH_HASH_TABLE_ELEMENT (*shared_hash_htab (dsm
.src
->vars
),
4290 variable_merge_over_src (var
, &dsm
);
4291 FOR_EACH_HASH_TABLE_ELEMENT (*shared_hash_htab (dsm
.cur
->vars
),
4293 variable_merge_over_cur (var
, &dsm
);
4295 if (dsm
.src_onepart_cnt
)
4296 dst_can_be_shared
= false;
4298 dataflow_set_destroy (src1
);
4301 /* Mark register equivalences. */
4304 dataflow_set_equiv_regs (dataflow_set
*set
)
4307 attrs
*list
, **listp
;
4309 for (i
= 0; i
< FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
; i
++)
4311 rtx canon
[NUM_MACHINE_MODES
];
4313 /* If the list is empty or one entry, no need to canonicalize
4315 if (set
->regs
[i
] == NULL
|| set
->regs
[i
]->next
== NULL
)
4318 memset (canon
, 0, sizeof (canon
));
4320 for (list
= set
->regs
[i
]; list
; list
= list
->next
)
4321 if (list
->offset
== 0 && dv_is_value_p (list
->dv
))
4323 rtx val
= dv_as_value (list
->dv
);
4324 rtx
*cvalp
= &canon
[(int)GET_MODE (val
)];
4327 if (canon_value_cmp (val
, cval
))
4331 for (list
= set
->regs
[i
]; list
; list
= list
->next
)
4332 if (list
->offset
== 0 && dv_onepart_p (list
->dv
))
4334 rtx cval
= canon
[(int)GET_MODE (list
->loc
)];
4339 if (dv_is_value_p (list
->dv
))
4341 rtx val
= dv_as_value (list
->dv
);
4346 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (val
) = true;
4347 set_variable_part (set
, val
, dv_from_value (cval
), 0,
4348 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
,
4352 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (cval
) = true;
4353 set_variable_part (set
, cval
, list
->dv
, 0,
4354 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
, NULL
, NO_INSERT
);
4357 for (listp
= &set
->regs
[i
]; (list
= *listp
);
4358 listp
= list
? &list
->next
: listp
)
4359 if (list
->offset
== 0 && dv_onepart_p (list
->dv
))
4361 rtx cval
= canon
[(int)GET_MODE (list
->loc
)];
4367 if (dv_is_value_p (list
->dv
))
4369 rtx val
= dv_as_value (list
->dv
);
4370 if (!VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (val
))
4374 slot
= shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert (set
->vars
, list
->dv
);
4375 canonicalize_values_star (slot
, set
);
4382 /* Remove any redundant values in the location list of VAR, which must
4383 be unshared and 1-part. */
4386 remove_duplicate_values (variable
*var
)
4388 location_chain
*node
, **nodep
;
4390 gcc_assert (var
->onepart
);
4391 gcc_assert (var
->n_var_parts
== 1);
4392 gcc_assert (var
->refcount
== 1);
4394 for (nodep
= &var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
; (node
= *nodep
); )
4396 if (GET_CODE (node
->loc
) == VALUE
)
4398 if (VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (node
->loc
))
4400 /* Remove duplicate value node. */
4401 *nodep
= node
->next
;
4406 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (node
->loc
) = true;
4408 nodep
= &node
->next
;
4411 for (node
= var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
; node
; node
= node
->next
)
4412 if (GET_CODE (node
->loc
) == VALUE
)
4414 gcc_assert (VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (node
->loc
));
4415 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (node
->loc
) = false;
4420 /* Hash table iteration argument passed to variable_post_merge. */
4421 struct dfset_post_merge
4423 /* The new input set for the current block. */
4425 /* Pointer to the permanent input set for the current block, or
4427 dataflow_set
**permp
;
4430 /* Create values for incoming expressions associated with one-part
4431 variables that don't have value numbers for them. */
4434 variable_post_merge_new_vals (variable
**slot
, dfset_post_merge
*dfpm
)
4436 dataflow_set
*set
= dfpm
->set
;
4437 variable
*var
= *slot
;
4438 location_chain
*node
;
4440 if (!var
->onepart
|| !var
->n_var_parts
)
4443 gcc_assert (var
->n_var_parts
== 1);
4445 if (dv_is_decl_p (var
->dv
))
4447 bool check_dupes
= false;
4450 for (node
= var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
; node
; node
= node
->next
)
4452 if (GET_CODE (node
->loc
) == VALUE
)
4453 gcc_assert (!VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (node
->loc
));
4454 else if (GET_CODE (node
->loc
) == REG
)
4456 attrs
*att
, **attp
, **curp
= NULL
;
4458 if (var
->refcount
!= 1)
4460 slot
= unshare_variable (set
, slot
, var
,
4461 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
);
4466 for (attp
= &set
->regs
[REGNO (node
->loc
)]; (att
= *attp
);
4468 if (att
->offset
== 0
4469 && GET_MODE (att
->loc
) == GET_MODE (node
->loc
))
4471 if (dv_is_value_p (att
->dv
))
4473 rtx cval
= dv_as_value (att
->dv
);
4478 else if (dv_as_opaque (att
->dv
) == dv_as_opaque (var
->dv
))
4486 if ((*curp
)->offset
== 0
4487 && GET_MODE ((*curp
)->loc
) == GET_MODE (node
->loc
)
4488 && dv_as_opaque ((*curp
)->dv
) == dv_as_opaque (var
->dv
))
4491 curp
= &(*curp
)->next
;
4502 *dfpm
->permp
= XNEW (dataflow_set
);
4503 dataflow_set_init (*dfpm
->permp
);
4506 for (att
= (*dfpm
->permp
)->regs
[REGNO (node
->loc
)];
4507 att
; att
= att
->next
)
4508 if (GET_MODE (att
->loc
) == GET_MODE (node
->loc
))
4510 gcc_assert (att
->offset
== 0
4511 && dv_is_value_p (att
->dv
));
4512 val_reset (set
, att
->dv
);
4519 cval
= dv_as_value (cdv
);
4523 /* Create a unique value to hold this register,
4524 that ought to be found and reused in
4525 subsequent rounds. */
4527 gcc_assert (!cselib_lookup (node
->loc
,
4528 GET_MODE (node
->loc
), 0,
4530 v
= cselib_lookup (node
->loc
, GET_MODE (node
->loc
), 1,
4532 cselib_preserve_value (v
);
4533 cselib_invalidate_rtx (node
->loc
);
4535 cdv
= dv_from_value (cval
);
4538 "Created new value %u:%u for reg %i\n",
4539 v
->uid
, v
->hash
, REGNO (node
->loc
));
4542 var_reg_decl_set (*dfpm
->permp
, node
->loc
,
4543 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
,
4544 cdv
, 0, NULL
, INSERT
);
4550 /* Remove attribute referring to the decl, which now
4551 uses the value for the register, already existing or
4552 to be added when we bring perm in. */
4560 remove_duplicate_values (var
);
4566 /* Reset values in the permanent set that are not associated with the
4567 chosen expression. */
4570 variable_post_merge_perm_vals (variable
**pslot
, dfset_post_merge
*dfpm
)
4572 dataflow_set
*set
= dfpm
->set
;
4573 variable
*pvar
= *pslot
, *var
;
4574 location_chain
*pnode
;
4578 gcc_assert (dv_is_value_p (pvar
->dv
)
4579 && pvar
->n_var_parts
== 1);
4580 pnode
= pvar
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
;
4583 && REG_P (pnode
->loc
));
4587 var
= shared_hash_find (set
->vars
, dv
);
4590 /* Although variable_post_merge_new_vals may have made decls
4591 non-star-canonical, values that pre-existed in canonical form
4592 remain canonical, and newly-created values reference a single
4593 REG, so they are canonical as well. Since VAR has the
4594 location list for a VALUE, using find_loc_in_1pdv for it is
4595 fine, since VALUEs don't map back to DECLs. */
4596 if (find_loc_in_1pdv (pnode
->loc
, var
, shared_hash_htab (set
->vars
)))
4598 val_reset (set
, dv
);
4601 for (att
= set
->regs
[REGNO (pnode
->loc
)]; att
; att
= att
->next
)
4602 if (att
->offset
== 0
4603 && GET_MODE (att
->loc
) == GET_MODE (pnode
->loc
)
4604 && dv_is_value_p (att
->dv
))
4607 /* If there is a value associated with this register already, create
4609 if (att
&& dv_as_value (att
->dv
) != dv_as_value (dv
))
4611 rtx cval
= dv_as_value (att
->dv
);
4612 set_variable_part (set
, cval
, dv
, 0, pnode
->init
, NULL
, INSERT
);
4613 set_variable_part (set
, dv_as_value (dv
), att
->dv
, 0, pnode
->init
,
4618 attrs_list_insert (&set
->regs
[REGNO (pnode
->loc
)],
4620 variable_union (pvar
, set
);
4626 /* Just checking stuff and registering register attributes for
4630 dataflow_post_merge_adjust (dataflow_set
*set
, dataflow_set
**permp
)
4632 struct dfset_post_merge dfpm
;
4637 shared_hash_htab (set
->vars
)
4638 ->traverse
<dfset_post_merge
*, variable_post_merge_new_vals
> (&dfpm
);
4640 shared_hash_htab ((*permp
)->vars
)
4641 ->traverse
<dfset_post_merge
*, variable_post_merge_perm_vals
> (&dfpm
);
4642 shared_hash_htab (set
->vars
)
4643 ->traverse
<dataflow_set
*, canonicalize_values_star
> (set
);
4644 shared_hash_htab (set
->vars
)
4645 ->traverse
<dataflow_set
*, canonicalize_vars_star
> (set
);
4648 /* Return a node whose loc is a MEM that refers to EXPR in the
4649 location list of a one-part variable or value VAR, or in that of
4650 any values recursively mentioned in the location lists. */
4652 static location_chain
*
4653 find_mem_expr_in_1pdv (tree expr
, rtx val
, variable_table_type
*vars
)
4655 location_chain
*node
;
4658 location_chain
*where
= NULL
;
4663 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (val
) == VALUE
4664 && !VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (val
));
4666 dv
= dv_from_value (val
);
4667 var
= vars
->find_with_hash (dv
, dv_htab_hash (dv
));
4672 gcc_assert (var
->onepart
);
4674 if (!var
->n_var_parts
)
4677 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (val
) = true;
4679 for (node
= var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
; node
; node
= node
->next
)
4680 if (MEM_P (node
->loc
)
4681 && MEM_EXPR (node
->loc
) == expr
4682 && int_mem_offset (node
->loc
) == 0)
4687 else if (GET_CODE (node
->loc
) == VALUE
4688 && !VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (node
->loc
)
4689 && (where
= find_mem_expr_in_1pdv (expr
, node
->loc
, vars
)))
4692 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (val
) = false;
4697 /* Return TRUE if the value of MEM may vary across a call. */
4700 mem_dies_at_call (rtx mem
)
4702 tree expr
= MEM_EXPR (mem
);
4708 decl
= get_base_address (expr
);
4716 return (may_be_aliased (decl
)
4717 || (!TREE_READONLY (decl
) && is_global_var (decl
)));
4720 /* Remove all MEMs from the location list of a hash table entry for a
4721 one-part variable, except those whose MEM attributes map back to
4722 the variable itself, directly or within a VALUE. */
4725 dataflow_set_preserve_mem_locs (variable
**slot
, dataflow_set
*set
)
4727 variable
*var
= *slot
;
4729 if (var
->onepart
== ONEPART_VDECL
|| var
->onepart
== ONEPART_DEXPR
)
4731 tree decl
= dv_as_decl (var
->dv
);
4732 location_chain
*loc
, **locp
;
4733 bool changed
= false;
4735 if (!var
->n_var_parts
)
4738 gcc_assert (var
->n_var_parts
== 1);
4740 if (shared_var_p (var
, set
->vars
))
4742 for (loc
= var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
; loc
; loc
= loc
->next
)
4744 /* We want to remove dying MEMs that don't refer to DECL. */
4745 if (GET_CODE (loc
->loc
) == MEM
4746 && (MEM_EXPR (loc
->loc
) != decl
4747 || int_mem_offset (loc
->loc
) != 0)
4748 && mem_dies_at_call (loc
->loc
))
4750 /* We want to move here MEMs that do refer to DECL. */
4751 else if (GET_CODE (loc
->loc
) == VALUE
4752 && find_mem_expr_in_1pdv (decl
, loc
->loc
,
4753 shared_hash_htab (set
->vars
)))
4760 slot
= unshare_variable (set
, slot
, var
, VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNKNOWN
);
4762 gcc_assert (var
->n_var_parts
== 1);
4765 for (locp
= &var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
, loc
= *locp
;
4768 rtx old_loc
= loc
->loc
;
4769 if (GET_CODE (old_loc
) == VALUE
)
4771 location_chain
*mem_node
4772 = find_mem_expr_in_1pdv (decl
, loc
->loc
,
4773 shared_hash_htab (set
->vars
));
4775 /* ??? This picks up only one out of multiple MEMs that
4776 refer to the same variable. Do we ever need to be
4777 concerned about dealing with more than one, or, given
4778 that they should all map to the same variable
4779 location, their addresses will have been merged and
4780 they will be regarded as equivalent? */
4783 loc
->loc
= mem_node
->loc
;
4784 loc
->set_src
= mem_node
->set_src
;
4785 loc
->init
= MIN (loc
->init
, mem_node
->init
);
4789 if (GET_CODE (loc
->loc
) != MEM
4790 || (MEM_EXPR (loc
->loc
) == decl
4791 && int_mem_offset (loc
->loc
) == 0)
4792 || !mem_dies_at_call (loc
->loc
))
4794 if (old_loc
!= loc
->loc
&& emit_notes
)
4796 if (old_loc
== var
->var_part
[0].cur_loc
)
4799 var
->var_part
[0].cur_loc
= NULL
;
4808 if (old_loc
== var
->var_part
[0].cur_loc
)
4811 var
->var_part
[0].cur_loc
= NULL
;
4818 if (!var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
)
4824 variable_was_changed (var
, set
);
4830 /* Remove all MEMs from the location list of a hash table entry for a
4831 onepart variable. */
4834 dataflow_set_remove_mem_locs (variable
**slot
, dataflow_set
*set
)
4836 variable
*var
= *slot
;
4838 if (var
->onepart
!= NOT_ONEPART
)
4840 location_chain
*loc
, **locp
;
4841 bool changed
= false;
4844 gcc_assert (var
->n_var_parts
== 1);
4846 if (shared_var_p (var
, set
->vars
))
4848 for (loc
= var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
; loc
; loc
= loc
->next
)
4849 if (GET_CODE (loc
->loc
) == MEM
4850 && mem_dies_at_call (loc
->loc
))
4856 slot
= unshare_variable (set
, slot
, var
, VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNKNOWN
);
4858 gcc_assert (var
->n_var_parts
== 1);
4861 if (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
))
4862 cur_loc
= VAR_LOC_FROM (var
);
4864 cur_loc
= var
->var_part
[0].cur_loc
;
4866 for (locp
= &var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
, loc
= *locp
;
4869 if (GET_CODE (loc
->loc
) != MEM
4870 || !mem_dies_at_call (loc
->loc
))
4877 /* If we have deleted the location which was last emitted
4878 we have to emit new location so add the variable to set
4879 of changed variables. */
4880 if (cur_loc
== loc
->loc
)
4883 var
->var_part
[0].cur_loc
= NULL
;
4884 if (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
))
4885 VAR_LOC_FROM (var
) = NULL
;
4890 if (!var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
)
4896 variable_was_changed (var
, set
);
4902 /* Remove all variable-location information about call-clobbered
4903 registers, as well as associations between MEMs and VALUEs. */
4906 dataflow_set_clear_at_call (dataflow_set
*set
, rtx_insn
*call_insn
)
4909 hard_reg_set_iterator hrsi
;
4911 HARD_REG_SET callee_clobbers
4912 = insn_callee_abi (call_insn
).full_reg_clobbers ();
4914 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_HARD_REG_SET (callee_clobbers
, 0, r
, hrsi
)
4915 var_regno_delete (set
, r
);
4917 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_BIND_INSNS
)
4919 set
->traversed_vars
= set
->vars
;
4920 shared_hash_htab (set
->vars
)
4921 ->traverse
<dataflow_set
*, dataflow_set_preserve_mem_locs
> (set
);
4922 set
->traversed_vars
= set
->vars
;
4923 shared_hash_htab (set
->vars
)
4924 ->traverse
<dataflow_set
*, dataflow_set_remove_mem_locs
> (set
);
4925 set
->traversed_vars
= NULL
;
4930 variable_part_different_p (variable_part
*vp1
, variable_part
*vp2
)
4932 location_chain
*lc1
, *lc2
;
4934 for (lc1
= vp1
->loc_chain
; lc1
; lc1
= lc1
->next
)
4936 for (lc2
= vp2
->loc_chain
; lc2
; lc2
= lc2
->next
)
4938 if (REG_P (lc1
->loc
) && REG_P (lc2
->loc
))
4940 if (REGNO (lc1
->loc
) == REGNO (lc2
->loc
))
4943 if (rtx_equal_p (lc1
->loc
, lc2
->loc
))
4952 /* Return true if one-part variables VAR1 and VAR2 are different.
4953 They must be in canonical order. */
4956 onepart_variable_different_p (variable
*var1
, variable
*var2
)
4958 location_chain
*lc1
, *lc2
;
4963 gcc_assert (var1
->n_var_parts
== 1
4964 && var2
->n_var_parts
== 1);
4966 lc1
= var1
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
;
4967 lc2
= var2
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
;
4969 gcc_assert (lc1
&& lc2
);
4973 if (loc_cmp (lc1
->loc
, lc2
->loc
))
4982 /* Return true if one-part variables VAR1 and VAR2 are different.
4983 They must be in canonical order. */
4986 dump_onepart_variable_differences (variable
*var1
, variable
*var2
)
4988 location_chain
*lc1
, *lc2
;
4990 gcc_assert (var1
!= var2
);
4991 gcc_assert (dump_file
);
4992 gcc_assert (dv_as_opaque (var1
->dv
) == dv_as_opaque (var2
->dv
));
4993 gcc_assert (var1
->n_var_parts
== 1
4994 && var2
->n_var_parts
== 1);
4996 lc1
= var1
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
;
4997 lc2
= var2
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
;
4999 gcc_assert (lc1
&& lc2
);
5003 switch (loc_cmp (lc1
->loc
, lc2
->loc
))
5006 fprintf (dump_file
, "removed: ");
5007 print_rtl_single (dump_file
, lc1
->loc
);
5013 fprintf (dump_file
, "added: ");
5014 print_rtl_single (dump_file
, lc2
->loc
);
5026 fprintf (dump_file
, "removed: ");
5027 print_rtl_single (dump_file
, lc1
->loc
);
5033 fprintf (dump_file
, "added: ");
5034 print_rtl_single (dump_file
, lc2
->loc
);
5039 /* Return true if variables VAR1 and VAR2 are different. */
5042 variable_different_p (variable
*var1
, variable
*var2
)
5049 if (var1
->onepart
!= var2
->onepart
)
5052 if (var1
->n_var_parts
!= var2
->n_var_parts
)
5055 if (var1
->onepart
&& var1
->n_var_parts
)
5057 gcc_checking_assert (dv_as_opaque (var1
->dv
) == dv_as_opaque (var2
->dv
)
5058 && var1
->n_var_parts
== 1);
5059 /* One-part values have locations in a canonical order. */
5060 return onepart_variable_different_p (var1
, var2
);
5063 for (i
= 0; i
< var1
->n_var_parts
; i
++)
5065 if (VAR_PART_OFFSET (var1
, i
) != VAR_PART_OFFSET (var2
, i
))
5067 if (variable_part_different_p (&var1
->var_part
[i
], &var2
->var_part
[i
]))
5069 if (variable_part_different_p (&var2
->var_part
[i
], &var1
->var_part
[i
]))
5075 /* Return true if dataflow sets OLD_SET and NEW_SET differ. */
5078 dataflow_set_different (dataflow_set
*old_set
, dataflow_set
*new_set
)
5080 variable_iterator_type hi
;
5082 bool diffound
= false;
5083 bool details
= (dump_file
&& (dump_flags
& TDF_DETAILS
));
5095 if (old_set
->vars
== new_set
->vars
)
5098 if (shared_hash_htab (old_set
->vars
)->elements ()
5099 != shared_hash_htab (new_set
->vars
)->elements ())
5102 FOR_EACH_HASH_TABLE_ELEMENT (*shared_hash_htab (old_set
->vars
),
5105 variable_table_type
*htab
= shared_hash_htab (new_set
->vars
);
5106 variable
*var2
= htab
->find_with_hash (var1
->dv
, dv_htab_hash (var1
->dv
));
5110 if (dump_file
&& (dump_flags
& TDF_DETAILS
))
5112 fprintf (dump_file
, "dataflow difference found: removal of:\n");
5117 else if (variable_different_p (var1
, var2
))
5121 fprintf (dump_file
, "dataflow difference found: "
5122 "old and new follow:\n");
5124 if (dv_onepart_p (var1
->dv
))
5125 dump_onepart_variable_differences (var1
, var2
);
5132 /* There's no need to traverse the second hashtab unless we want to
5133 print the details. If both have the same number of elements and
5134 the second one had all entries found in the first one, then the
5135 second can't have any extra entries. */
5139 FOR_EACH_HASH_TABLE_ELEMENT (*shared_hash_htab (new_set
->vars
),
5142 variable_table_type
*htab
= shared_hash_htab (old_set
->vars
);
5143 variable
*var2
= htab
->find_with_hash (var1
->dv
, dv_htab_hash (var1
->dv
));
5148 fprintf (dump_file
, "dataflow difference found: addition of:\n");
5160 /* Free the contents of dataflow set SET. */
5163 dataflow_set_destroy (dataflow_set
*set
)
5167 for (i
= 0; i
< FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
; i
++)
5168 attrs_list_clear (&set
->regs
[i
]);
5170 shared_hash_destroy (set
->vars
);
5174 /* Return true if T is a tracked parameter with non-degenerate record type. */
5177 tracked_record_parameter_p (tree t
)
5179 if (TREE_CODE (t
) != PARM_DECL
)
5182 if (DECL_MODE (t
) == BLKmode
)
5185 tree type
= TREE_TYPE (t
);
5186 if (TREE_CODE (type
) != RECORD_TYPE
)
5189 if (TYPE_FIELDS (type
) == NULL_TREE
5190 || DECL_CHAIN (TYPE_FIELDS (type
)) == NULL_TREE
)
5196 /* Shall EXPR be tracked? */
5199 track_expr_p (tree expr
, bool need_rtl
)
5204 if (TREE_CODE (expr
) == DEBUG_EXPR_DECL
)
5205 return DECL_RTL_SET_P (expr
);
5207 /* If EXPR is not a parameter or a variable do not track it. */
5208 if (!VAR_P (expr
) && TREE_CODE (expr
) != PARM_DECL
)
5211 /* It also must have a name... */
5212 if (!DECL_NAME (expr
) && need_rtl
)
5215 /* ... and a RTL assigned to it. */
5216 decl_rtl
= DECL_RTL_IF_SET (expr
);
5217 if (!decl_rtl
&& need_rtl
)
5220 /* If this expression is really a debug alias of some other declaration, we
5221 don't need to track this expression if the ultimate declaration is
5224 if (VAR_P (realdecl
) && DECL_HAS_DEBUG_EXPR_P (realdecl
))
5226 realdecl
= DECL_DEBUG_EXPR (realdecl
);
5227 if (!DECL_P (realdecl
))
5229 if (handled_component_p (realdecl
)
5230 || (TREE_CODE (realdecl
) == MEM_REF
5231 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (realdecl
, 0)) == ADDR_EXPR
))
5233 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize
, bitpos
;
5236 = get_ref_base_and_extent_hwi (realdecl
, &bitpos
,
5237 &bitsize
, &reverse
);
5239 || !DECL_P (innerdecl
)
5240 || DECL_IGNORED_P (innerdecl
)
5241 /* Do not track declarations for parts of tracked record
5242 parameters since we want to track them as a whole. */
5243 || tracked_record_parameter_p (innerdecl
)
5244 || TREE_STATIC (innerdecl
)
5246 || bitpos
+ bitsize
> 256)
5256 /* Do not track EXPR if REALDECL it should be ignored for debugging
5258 if (DECL_IGNORED_P (realdecl
))
5261 /* Do not track global variables until we are able to emit correct location
5263 if (TREE_STATIC (realdecl
))
5266 /* When the EXPR is a DECL for alias of some variable (see example)
5267 the TREE_STATIC flag is not used. Disable tracking all DECLs whose
5268 DECL_RTL contains SYMBOL_REF.
5271 extern char **_dl_argv_internal __attribute__ ((alias ("_dl_argv")));
5274 if (decl_rtl
&& MEM_P (decl_rtl
)
5275 && contains_symbol_ref_p (XEXP (decl_rtl
, 0)))
5278 /* If RTX is a memory it should not be very large (because it would be
5279 an array or struct). */
5280 if (decl_rtl
&& MEM_P (decl_rtl
))
5282 /* Do not track structures and arrays. */
5283 if ((GET_MODE (decl_rtl
) == BLKmode
5284 || AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (realdecl
)))
5285 && !tracked_record_parameter_p (realdecl
))
5287 if (MEM_SIZE_KNOWN_P (decl_rtl
)
5288 && maybe_gt (MEM_SIZE (decl_rtl
), MAX_VAR_PARTS
))
5292 DECL_CHANGED (expr
) = 0;
5293 DECL_CHANGED (realdecl
) = 0;
5297 /* Determine whether a given LOC refers to the same variable part as
5301 same_variable_part_p (rtx loc
, tree expr
, poly_int64 offset
)
5306 if (! DECL_P (expr
))
5311 expr2
= REG_EXPR (loc
);
5312 offset2
= REG_OFFSET (loc
);
5314 else if (MEM_P (loc
))
5316 expr2
= MEM_EXPR (loc
);
5317 offset2
= int_mem_offset (loc
);
5322 if (! expr2
|| ! DECL_P (expr2
))
5325 expr
= var_debug_decl (expr
);
5326 expr2
= var_debug_decl (expr2
);
5328 return (expr
== expr2
&& known_eq (offset
, offset2
));
5331 /* LOC is a REG or MEM that we would like to track if possible.
5332 If EXPR is null, we don't know what expression LOC refers to,
5333 otherwise it refers to EXPR + OFFSET. STORE_REG_P is true if
5334 LOC is an lvalue register.
5336 Return true if EXPR is nonnull and if LOC, or some lowpart of it,
5337 is something we can track. When returning true, store the mode of
5338 the lowpart we can track in *MODE_OUT (if nonnull) and its offset
5339 from EXPR in *OFFSET_OUT (if nonnull). */
5342 track_loc_p (rtx loc
, tree expr
, poly_int64 offset
, bool store_reg_p
,
5343 machine_mode
*mode_out
, HOST_WIDE_INT
*offset_out
)
5347 if (expr
== NULL
|| !track_expr_p (expr
, true))
5350 /* If REG was a paradoxical subreg, its REG_ATTRS will describe the
5351 whole subreg, but only the old inner part is really relevant. */
5352 mode
= GET_MODE (loc
);
5353 if (REG_P (loc
) && !HARD_REGISTER_NUM_P (ORIGINAL_REGNO (loc
)))
5355 machine_mode pseudo_mode
;
5357 pseudo_mode
= PSEUDO_REGNO_MODE (ORIGINAL_REGNO (loc
));
5358 if (paradoxical_subreg_p (mode
, pseudo_mode
))
5360 offset
+= byte_lowpart_offset (pseudo_mode
, mode
);
5365 /* If LOC is a paradoxical lowpart of EXPR, refer to EXPR itself.
5366 Do the same if we are storing to a register and EXPR occupies
5367 the whole of register LOC; in that case, the whole of EXPR is
5368 being changed. We exclude complex modes from the second case
5369 because the real and imaginary parts are represented as separate
5370 pseudo registers, even if the whole complex value fits into one
5372 if ((paradoxical_subreg_p (mode
, DECL_MODE (expr
))
5374 && !COMPLEX_MODE_P (DECL_MODE (expr
))
5375 && hard_regno_nregs (REGNO (loc
), DECL_MODE (expr
)) == 1))
5376 && known_eq (offset
+ byte_lowpart_offset (DECL_MODE (expr
), mode
), 0))
5378 mode
= DECL_MODE (expr
);
5382 HOST_WIDE_INT const_offset
;
5383 if (!track_offset_p (offset
, &const_offset
))
5389 *offset_out
= const_offset
;
5393 /* Return the MODE lowpart of LOC, or null if LOC is not something we
5394 want to track. When returning nonnull, make sure that the attributes
5395 on the returned value are updated. */
5398 var_lowpart (machine_mode mode
, rtx loc
)
5402 if (GET_MODE (loc
) == mode
)
5405 if (!REG_P (loc
) && !MEM_P (loc
))
5408 poly_uint64 offset
= byte_lowpart_offset (mode
, GET_MODE (loc
));
5411 return adjust_address_nv (loc
, mode
, offset
);
5413 poly_uint64 reg_offset
= subreg_lowpart_offset (mode
, GET_MODE (loc
));
5414 regno
= REGNO (loc
) + subreg_regno_offset (REGNO (loc
), GET_MODE (loc
),
5416 return gen_rtx_REG_offset (loc
, mode
, regno
, offset
);
5419 /* Carry information about uses and stores while walking rtx. */
5421 struct count_use_info
5423 /* The insn where the RTX is. */
5426 /* The basic block where insn is. */
5429 /* The array of n_sets sets in the insn, as determined by cselib. */
5430 struct cselib_set
*sets
;
5433 /* True if we're counting stores, false otherwise. */
5437 /* Find a VALUE corresponding to X. */
5439 static inline cselib_val
*
5440 find_use_val (rtx x
, machine_mode mode
, struct count_use_info
*cui
)
5446 /* This is called after uses are set up and before stores are
5447 processed by cselib, so it's safe to look up srcs, but not
5448 dsts. So we look up expressions that appear in srcs or in
5449 dest expressions, but we search the sets array for dests of
5453 /* Some targets represent memset and memcpy patterns
5454 by (set (mem:BLK ...) (reg:[QHSD]I ...)) or
5455 (set (mem:BLK ...) (const_int ...)) or
5456 (set (mem:BLK ...) (mem:BLK ...)). Don't return anything
5457 in that case, otherwise we end up with mode mismatches. */
5458 if (mode
== BLKmode
&& MEM_P (x
))
5460 for (i
= 0; i
< cui
->n_sets
; i
++)
5461 if (cui
->sets
[i
].dest
== x
)
5462 return cui
->sets
[i
].src_elt
;
5465 return cselib_lookup (x
, mode
, 0, VOIDmode
);
5471 /* Replace all registers and addresses in an expression with VALUE
5472 expressions that map back to them, unless the expression is a
5473 register. If no mapping is or can be performed, returns NULL. */
5476 replace_expr_with_values (rtx loc
)
5478 if (REG_P (loc
) || GET_CODE (loc
) == ENTRY_VALUE
)
5480 else if (MEM_P (loc
))
5482 cselib_val
*addr
= cselib_lookup (XEXP (loc
, 0),
5483 get_address_mode (loc
), 0,
5486 return replace_equiv_address_nv (loc
, addr
->val_rtx
);
5491 return cselib_subst_to_values (loc
, VOIDmode
);
5494 /* Return true if X contains a DEBUG_EXPR. */
5497 rtx_debug_expr_p (const_rtx x
)
5499 subrtx_iterator::array_type array
;
5500 FOR_EACH_SUBRTX (iter
, array
, x
, ALL
)
5501 if (GET_CODE (*iter
) == DEBUG_EXPR
)
5506 /* Determine what kind of micro operation to choose for a USE. Return
5507 MO_CLOBBER if no micro operation is to be generated. */
5509 static enum micro_operation_type
5510 use_type (rtx loc
, struct count_use_info
*cui
, machine_mode
*modep
)
5514 if (cui
&& cui
->sets
)
5516 if (GET_CODE (loc
) == VAR_LOCATION
)
5518 if (track_expr_p (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (loc
), false))
5520 rtx ploc
= PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc
);
5521 if (! VAR_LOC_UNKNOWN_P (ploc
))
5523 cselib_val
*val
= cselib_lookup (ploc
, GET_MODE (loc
), 1,
5526 /* ??? flag_float_store and volatile mems are never
5527 given values, but we could in theory use them for
5529 gcc_assert (val
|| 1);
5537 if (REG_P (loc
) || MEM_P (loc
))
5540 *modep
= GET_MODE (loc
);
5544 || (find_use_val (loc
, GET_MODE (loc
), cui
)
5545 && cselib_lookup (XEXP (loc
, 0),
5546 get_address_mode (loc
), 0,
5552 cselib_val
*val
= find_use_val (loc
, GET_MODE (loc
), cui
);
5554 if (val
&& !cselib_preserved_value_p (val
))
5562 gcc_assert (REGNO (loc
) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
);
5564 if (loc
== cfa_base_rtx
)
5566 expr
= REG_EXPR (loc
);
5569 return MO_USE_NO_VAR
;
5570 else if (target_for_debug_bind (var_debug_decl (expr
)))
5572 else if (track_loc_p (loc
, expr
, REG_OFFSET (loc
),
5573 false, modep
, NULL
))
5576 return MO_USE_NO_VAR
;
5578 else if (MEM_P (loc
))
5580 expr
= MEM_EXPR (loc
);
5584 else if (target_for_debug_bind (var_debug_decl (expr
)))
5586 else if (track_loc_p (loc
, expr
, int_mem_offset (loc
),
5588 /* Multi-part variables shouldn't refer to one-part
5589 variable names such as VALUEs (never happens) or
5590 DEBUG_EXPRs (only happens in the presence of debug
5592 && (!MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_BIND_INSNS
5593 || !rtx_debug_expr_p (XEXP (loc
, 0))))
5602 /* Log to OUT information about micro-operation MOPT involving X in
5606 log_op_type (rtx x
, basic_block bb
, rtx_insn
*insn
,
5607 enum micro_operation_type mopt
, FILE *out
)
5609 fprintf (out
, "bb %i op %i insn %i %s ",
5610 bb
->index
, VTI (bb
)->mos
.length (),
5611 INSN_UID (insn
), micro_operation_type_name
[mopt
]);
5612 print_inline_rtx (out
, x
, 2);
5616 /* Tell whether the CONCAT used to holds a VALUE and its location
5617 needs value resolution, i.e., an attempt of mapping the location
5618 back to other incoming values. */
5619 #define VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION(x) \
5620 (RTL_FLAG_CHECK1 ("VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION", (x), CONCAT)->volatil)
5621 /* Whether the location in the CONCAT is a tracked expression, that
5622 should also be handled like a MO_USE. */
5623 #define VAL_HOLDS_TRACK_EXPR(x) \
5624 (RTL_FLAG_CHECK1 ("VAL_HOLDS_TRACK_EXPR", (x), CONCAT)->used)
5625 /* Whether the location in the CONCAT should be handled like a MO_COPY
5627 #define VAL_EXPR_IS_COPIED(x) \
5628 (RTL_FLAG_CHECK1 ("VAL_EXPR_IS_COPIED", (x), CONCAT)->jump)
5629 /* Whether the location in the CONCAT should be handled like a
5630 MO_CLOBBER as well. */
5631 #define VAL_EXPR_IS_CLOBBERED(x) \
5632 (RTL_FLAG_CHECK1 ("VAL_EXPR_IS_CLOBBERED", (x), CONCAT)->unchanging)
5634 /* All preserved VALUEs. */
5635 static vec
<rtx
> preserved_values
;
5637 /* Ensure VAL is preserved and remember it in a vector for vt_emit_notes. */
5640 preserve_value (cselib_val
*val
)
5642 cselib_preserve_value (val
);
5643 preserved_values
.safe_push (val
->val_rtx
);
5646 /* Helper function for MO_VAL_LOC handling. Return non-zero if
5647 any rtxes not suitable for CONST use not replaced by VALUEs
5651 non_suitable_const (const_rtx x
)
5653 subrtx_iterator::array_type array
;
5654 FOR_EACH_SUBRTX (iter
, array
, x
, ALL
)
5656 const_rtx x
= *iter
;
5657 switch (GET_CODE (x
))
5667 if (!MEM_READONLY_P (x
))
5677 /* Add uses (register and memory references) LOC which will be tracked
5678 to VTI (bb)->mos. */
5681 add_uses (rtx loc
, struct count_use_info
*cui
)
5683 machine_mode mode
= VOIDmode
;
5684 enum micro_operation_type type
= use_type (loc
, cui
, &mode
);
5686 if (type
!= MO_CLOBBER
)
5688 basic_block bb
= cui
->bb
;
5692 mo
.u
.loc
= type
== MO_USE
? var_lowpart (mode
, loc
) : loc
;
5693 mo
.insn
= cui
->insn
;
5695 if (type
== MO_VAL_LOC
)
5698 rtx vloc
= PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (oloc
);
5701 gcc_assert (cui
->sets
);
5704 && !REG_P (XEXP (vloc
, 0))
5705 && !MEM_P (XEXP (vloc
, 0)))
5708 machine_mode address_mode
= get_address_mode (mloc
);
5710 = cselib_lookup (XEXP (mloc
, 0), address_mode
, 0,
5713 if (val
&& !cselib_preserved_value_p (val
))
5714 preserve_value (val
);
5717 if (CONSTANT_P (vloc
)
5718 && (GET_CODE (vloc
) != CONST
|| non_suitable_const (vloc
)))
5719 /* For constants don't look up any value. */;
5720 else if (!VAR_LOC_UNKNOWN_P (vloc
) && !unsuitable_loc (vloc
)
5721 && (val
= find_use_val (vloc
, GET_MODE (oloc
), cui
)))
5724 enum micro_operation_type type2
;
5726 bool resolvable
= REG_P (vloc
) || MEM_P (vloc
);
5729 nloc
= replace_expr_with_values (vloc
);
5733 oloc
= shallow_copy_rtx (oloc
);
5734 PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (oloc
) = nloc
;
5737 oloc
= gen_rtx_CONCAT (mode
, val
->val_rtx
, oloc
);
5739 type2
= use_type (vloc
, 0, &mode2
);
5741 gcc_assert (type2
== MO_USE
|| type2
== MO_USE_NO_VAR
5742 || type2
== MO_CLOBBER
);
5744 if (type2
== MO_CLOBBER
5745 && !cselib_preserved_value_p (val
))
5747 VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION (oloc
) = resolvable
;
5748 preserve_value (val
);
5751 else if (!VAR_LOC_UNKNOWN_P (vloc
))
5753 oloc
= shallow_copy_rtx (oloc
);
5754 PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (oloc
) = gen_rtx_UNKNOWN_VAR_LOC ();
5759 else if (type
== MO_VAL_USE
)
5761 machine_mode mode2
= VOIDmode
;
5762 enum micro_operation_type type2
;
5763 cselib_val
*val
= find_use_val (loc
, GET_MODE (loc
), cui
);
5764 rtx vloc
, oloc
= loc
, nloc
;
5766 gcc_assert (cui
->sets
);
5769 && !REG_P (XEXP (oloc
, 0))
5770 && !MEM_P (XEXP (oloc
, 0)))
5773 machine_mode address_mode
= get_address_mode (mloc
);
5775 = cselib_lookup (XEXP (mloc
, 0), address_mode
, 0,
5778 if (val
&& !cselib_preserved_value_p (val
))
5779 preserve_value (val
);
5782 type2
= use_type (loc
, 0, &mode2
);
5784 gcc_assert (type2
== MO_USE
|| type2
== MO_USE_NO_VAR
5785 || type2
== MO_CLOBBER
);
5787 if (type2
== MO_USE
)
5788 vloc
= var_lowpart (mode2
, loc
);
5792 /* The loc of a MO_VAL_USE may have two forms:
5794 (concat val src): val is at src, a value-based
5797 (concat (concat val use) src): same as above, with use as
5798 the MO_USE tracked value, if it differs from src.
5802 gcc_checking_assert (REG_P (loc
) || MEM_P (loc
));
5803 nloc
= replace_expr_with_values (loc
);
5808 oloc
= gen_rtx_CONCAT (mode2
, val
->val_rtx
, vloc
);
5810 oloc
= val
->val_rtx
;
5812 mo
.u
.loc
= gen_rtx_CONCAT (mode
, oloc
, nloc
);
5814 if (type2
== MO_USE
)
5815 VAL_HOLDS_TRACK_EXPR (mo
.u
.loc
) = 1;
5816 if (!cselib_preserved_value_p (val
))
5818 VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION (mo
.u
.loc
) = 1;
5819 preserve_value (val
);
5823 gcc_assert (type
== MO_USE
|| type
== MO_USE_NO_VAR
);
5825 if (dump_file
&& (dump_flags
& TDF_DETAILS
))
5826 log_op_type (mo
.u
.loc
, cui
->bb
, cui
->insn
, mo
.type
, dump_file
);
5827 VTI (bb
)->mos
.safe_push (mo
);
5831 /* Helper function for finding all uses of REG/MEM in X in insn INSN. */
5834 add_uses_1 (rtx
*x
, void *cui
)
5836 subrtx_var_iterator::array_type array
;
5837 FOR_EACH_SUBRTX_VAR (iter
, array
, *x
, NONCONST
)
5838 add_uses (*iter
, (struct count_use_info
*) cui
);
5841 /* This is the value used during expansion of locations. We want it
5842 to be unbounded, so that variables expanded deep in a recursion
5843 nest are fully evaluated, so that their values are cached
5844 correctly. We avoid recursion cycles through other means, and we
5845 don't unshare RTL, so excess complexity is not a problem. */
5846 #define EXPR_DEPTH (INT_MAX)
5847 /* We use this to keep too-complex expressions from being emitted as
5848 location notes, and then to debug information. Users can trade
5849 compile time for ridiculously complex expressions, although they're
5850 seldom useful, and they may often have to be discarded as not
5851 representable anyway. */
5852 #define EXPR_USE_DEPTH (param_max_vartrack_expr_depth)
5854 /* Attempt to reverse the EXPR operation in the debug info and record
5855 it in the cselib table. Say for reg1 = reg2 + 6 even when reg2 is
5856 no longer live we can express its value as VAL - 6. */
5859 reverse_op (rtx val
, const_rtx expr
, rtx_insn
*insn
)
5863 struct elt_loc_list
*l
;
5867 if (GET_CODE (expr
) != SET
)
5870 if (!REG_P (SET_DEST (expr
)) || GET_MODE (val
) != GET_MODE (SET_DEST (expr
)))
5873 src
= SET_SRC (expr
);
5874 switch (GET_CODE (src
))
5881 if (!REG_P (XEXP (src
, 0)))
5886 if (!REG_P (XEXP (src
, 0)) && !MEM_P (XEXP (src
, 0)))
5893 if (!SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (GET_MODE (src
)) || XEXP (src
, 0) == cfa_base_rtx
)
5896 v
= cselib_lookup (XEXP (src
, 0), GET_MODE (XEXP (src
, 0)), 0, VOIDmode
);
5897 if (!v
|| !cselib_preserved_value_p (v
))
5900 /* Use canonical V to avoid creating multiple redundant expressions
5901 for different VALUES equivalent to V. */
5902 v
= canonical_cselib_val (v
);
5904 /* Adding a reverse op isn't useful if V already has an always valid
5905 location. Ignore ENTRY_VALUE, while it is always constant, we should
5906 prefer non-ENTRY_VALUE locations whenever possible. */
5907 for (l
= v
->locs
, count
= 0; l
; l
= l
->next
, count
++)
5908 if (CONSTANT_P (l
->loc
)
5909 && (GET_CODE (l
->loc
) != CONST
|| !references_value_p (l
->loc
, 0)))
5911 /* Avoid creating too large locs lists. */
5912 else if (count
== param_max_vartrack_reverse_op_size
)
5915 switch (GET_CODE (src
))
5919 if (GET_MODE (v
->val_rtx
) != GET_MODE (val
))
5921 ret
= gen_rtx_fmt_e (GET_CODE (src
), GET_MODE (val
), val
);
5925 ret
= gen_lowpart_SUBREG (GET_MODE (v
->val_rtx
), val
);
5937 if (GET_MODE (v
->val_rtx
) != GET_MODE (val
))
5939 arg
= XEXP (src
, 1);
5940 if (!CONST_INT_P (arg
) && GET_CODE (arg
) != SYMBOL_REF
)
5942 arg
= cselib_expand_value_rtx (arg
, scratch_regs
, 5);
5943 if (arg
== NULL_RTX
)
5945 if (!CONST_INT_P (arg
) && GET_CODE (arg
) != SYMBOL_REF
)
5948 ret
= simplify_gen_binary (code
, GET_MODE (val
), val
, arg
);
5954 cselib_add_permanent_equiv (v
, ret
, insn
);
5957 /* Add stores (register and memory references) LOC which will be tracked
5958 to VTI (bb)->mos. EXPR is the RTL expression containing the store.
5959 CUIP->insn is instruction which the LOC is part of. */
5962 add_stores (rtx loc
, const_rtx expr
, void *cuip
)
5964 machine_mode mode
= VOIDmode
, mode2
;
5965 struct count_use_info
*cui
= (struct count_use_info
*)cuip
;
5966 basic_block bb
= cui
->bb
;
5968 rtx oloc
= loc
, nloc
, src
= NULL
;
5969 enum micro_operation_type type
= use_type (loc
, cui
, &mode
);
5970 bool track_p
= false;
5972 bool resolve
, preserve
;
5974 if (type
== MO_CLOBBER
)
5981 gcc_assert (loc
!= cfa_base_rtx
);
5982 if ((GET_CODE (expr
) == CLOBBER
&& type
!= MO_VAL_SET
)
5983 || !(track_p
= use_type (loc
, NULL
, &mode2
) == MO_USE
)
5984 || GET_CODE (expr
) == CLOBBER
)
5986 mo
.type
= MO_CLOBBER
;
5988 if (GET_CODE (expr
) == SET
5989 && (SET_DEST (expr
) == loc
5990 || (GET_CODE (SET_DEST (expr
)) == STRICT_LOW_PART
5991 && XEXP (SET_DEST (expr
), 0) == loc
))
5992 && !unsuitable_loc (SET_SRC (expr
))
5993 && find_use_val (loc
, mode
, cui
))
5995 gcc_checking_assert (type
== MO_VAL_SET
);
5996 mo
.u
.loc
= gen_rtx_SET (loc
, SET_SRC (expr
));
6001 if (GET_CODE (expr
) == SET
6002 && SET_DEST (expr
) == loc
6003 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (expr
)) != ASM_OPERANDS
)
6004 src
= var_lowpart (mode2
, SET_SRC (expr
));
6005 loc
= var_lowpart (mode2
, loc
);
6014 rtx xexpr
= gen_rtx_SET (loc
, src
);
6015 if (same_variable_part_p (src
, REG_EXPR (loc
), REG_OFFSET (loc
)))
6017 /* If this is an instruction copying (part of) a parameter
6018 passed by invisible reference to its register location,
6019 pretend it's a SET so that the initial memory location
6020 is discarded, as the parameter register can be reused
6021 for other purposes and we do not track locations based
6022 on generic registers. */
6025 && TREE_CODE (REG_EXPR (loc
)) == PARM_DECL
6026 && DECL_MODE (REG_EXPR (loc
)) != BLKmode
6027 && MEM_P (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (REG_EXPR (loc
)))
6028 && XEXP (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (REG_EXPR (loc
)), 0)
6039 mo
.insn
= cui
->insn
;
6041 else if (MEM_P (loc
)
6042 && ((track_p
= use_type (loc
, NULL
, &mode2
) == MO_USE
)
6045 if (MEM_P (loc
) && type
== MO_VAL_SET
6046 && !REG_P (XEXP (loc
, 0))
6047 && !MEM_P (XEXP (loc
, 0)))
6050 machine_mode address_mode
= get_address_mode (mloc
);
6051 cselib_val
*val
= cselib_lookup (XEXP (mloc
, 0),
6055 if (val
&& !cselib_preserved_value_p (val
))
6056 preserve_value (val
);
6059 if (GET_CODE (expr
) == CLOBBER
|| !track_p
)
6061 mo
.type
= MO_CLOBBER
;
6062 mo
.u
.loc
= track_p
? var_lowpart (mode2
, loc
) : loc
;
6066 if (GET_CODE (expr
) == SET
6067 && SET_DEST (expr
) == loc
6068 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (expr
)) != ASM_OPERANDS
)
6069 src
= var_lowpart (mode2
, SET_SRC (expr
));
6070 loc
= var_lowpart (mode2
, loc
);
6079 rtx xexpr
= gen_rtx_SET (loc
, src
);
6080 if (same_variable_part_p (SET_SRC (xexpr
),
6082 int_mem_offset (loc
)))
6089 mo
.insn
= cui
->insn
;
6094 if (type
!= MO_VAL_SET
)
6095 goto log_and_return
;
6097 v
= find_use_val (oloc
, mode
, cui
);
6100 goto log_and_return
;
6102 resolve
= preserve
= !cselib_preserved_value_p (v
);
6104 /* We cannot track values for multiple-part variables, so we track only
6105 locations for tracked record parameters. */
6109 && tracked_record_parameter_p (REG_EXPR (loc
)))
6111 /* Although we don't use the value here, it could be used later by the
6112 mere virtue of its existence as the operand of the reverse operation
6113 that gave rise to it (typically extension/truncation). Make sure it
6114 is preserved as required by vt_expand_var_loc_chain. */
6117 goto log_and_return
;
6120 if (loc
== stack_pointer_rtx
6121 && (maybe_ne (hard_frame_pointer_adjustment
, -1)
6122 || (!frame_pointer_needed
&& !ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
))
6124 cselib_set_value_sp_based (v
);
6126 /* Don't record MO_VAL_SET for VALUEs that can be described using
6127 cfa_base_rtx or cfa_base_rtx + CONST_INT, cselib already knows
6128 all the needed equivalences and they shouldn't change depending
6129 on which register holds that VALUE in some instruction. */
6130 if (!frame_pointer_needed
6132 && cselib_sp_derived_value_p (v
)
6133 && loc
== stack_pointer_rtx
)
6140 nloc
= replace_expr_with_values (oloc
);
6144 if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (cui
->insn
)) == COND_EXEC
)
6146 cselib_val
*oval
= cselib_lookup (oloc
, GET_MODE (oloc
), 0, VOIDmode
);
6150 gcc_assert (REG_P (oloc
) || MEM_P (oloc
));
6152 if (oval
&& !cselib_preserved_value_p (oval
))
6154 micro_operation moa
;
6156 preserve_value (oval
);
6158 moa
.type
= MO_VAL_USE
;
6159 moa
.u
.loc
= gen_rtx_CONCAT (mode
, oval
->val_rtx
, oloc
);
6160 VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION (moa
.u
.loc
) = 1;
6161 moa
.insn
= cui
->insn
;
6163 if (dump_file
&& (dump_flags
& TDF_DETAILS
))
6164 log_op_type (moa
.u
.loc
, cui
->bb
, cui
->insn
,
6165 moa
.type
, dump_file
);
6166 VTI (bb
)->mos
.safe_push (moa
);
6171 else if (resolve
&& GET_CODE (mo
.u
.loc
) == SET
)
6173 if (REG_P (SET_SRC (expr
)) || MEM_P (SET_SRC (expr
)))
6174 nloc
= replace_expr_with_values (SET_SRC (expr
));
6178 /* Avoid the mode mismatch between oexpr and expr. */
6179 if (!nloc
&& mode
!= mode2
)
6181 nloc
= SET_SRC (expr
);
6182 gcc_assert (oloc
== SET_DEST (expr
));
6185 if (nloc
&& nloc
!= SET_SRC (mo
.u
.loc
))
6186 oloc
= gen_rtx_SET (oloc
, nloc
);
6189 if (oloc
== SET_DEST (mo
.u
.loc
))
6190 /* No point in duplicating. */
6192 if (!REG_P (SET_SRC (mo
.u
.loc
)))
6198 if (GET_CODE (mo
.u
.loc
) == SET
6199 && oloc
== SET_DEST (mo
.u
.loc
))
6200 /* No point in duplicating. */
6206 loc
= gen_rtx_CONCAT (mode
, v
->val_rtx
, oloc
);
6208 if (mo
.u
.loc
!= oloc
)
6209 loc
= gen_rtx_CONCAT (GET_MODE (mo
.u
.loc
), loc
, mo
.u
.loc
);
6211 /* The loc of a MO_VAL_SET may have various forms:
6213 (concat val dst): dst now holds val
6215 (concat val (set dst src)): dst now holds val, copied from src
6217 (concat (concat val dstv) dst): dst now holds val; dstv is dst
6218 after replacing mems and non-top-level regs with values.
6220 (concat (concat val dstv) (set dst src)): dst now holds val,
6221 copied from src. dstv is a value-based representation of dst, if
6222 it differs from dst. If resolution is needed, src is a REG, and
6223 its mode is the same as that of val.
6225 (concat (concat val (set dstv srcv)) (set dst src)): src
6226 copied to dst, holding val. dstv and srcv are value-based
6227 representations of dst and src, respectively.
6231 if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (cui
->insn
)) != COND_EXEC
)
6232 reverse_op (v
->val_rtx
, expr
, cui
->insn
);
6237 VAL_HOLDS_TRACK_EXPR (loc
) = 1;
6240 VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION (loc
) = resolve
;
6243 if (mo
.type
== MO_CLOBBER
)
6244 VAL_EXPR_IS_CLOBBERED (loc
) = 1;
6245 if (mo
.type
== MO_COPY
)
6246 VAL_EXPR_IS_COPIED (loc
) = 1;
6248 mo
.type
= MO_VAL_SET
;
6251 if (dump_file
&& (dump_flags
& TDF_DETAILS
))
6252 log_op_type (mo
.u
.loc
, cui
->bb
, cui
->insn
, mo
.type
, dump_file
);
6253 VTI (bb
)->mos
.safe_push (mo
);
6256 /* Arguments to the call. */
6257 static rtx call_arguments
;
6259 /* Compute call_arguments. */
6262 prepare_call_arguments (basic_block bb
, rtx_insn
*insn
)
6265 rtx prev
, cur
, next
;
6266 rtx this_arg
= NULL_RTX
;
6267 tree type
= NULL_TREE
, t
, fndecl
= NULL_TREE
;
6268 tree obj_type_ref
= NULL_TREE
;
6269 CUMULATIVE_ARGS args_so_far_v
;
6270 cumulative_args_t args_so_far
;
6272 memset (&args_so_far_v
, 0, sizeof (args_so_far_v
));
6273 args_so_far
= pack_cumulative_args (&args_so_far_v
);
6274 call
= get_call_rtx_from (insn
);
6277 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (call
, 0), 0)) == SYMBOL_REF
)
6279 rtx symbol
= XEXP (XEXP (call
, 0), 0);
6280 if (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (symbol
))
6281 fndecl
= SYMBOL_REF_DECL (symbol
);
6283 if (fndecl
== NULL_TREE
)
6284 fndecl
= MEM_EXPR (XEXP (call
, 0));
6286 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (fndecl
)) != FUNCTION_TYPE
6287 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (fndecl
)) != METHOD_TYPE
)
6289 if (fndecl
&& TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (fndecl
)))
6290 type
= TREE_TYPE (fndecl
);
6291 if (fndecl
&& TREE_CODE (fndecl
) != FUNCTION_DECL
)
6293 if (TREE_CODE (fndecl
) == INDIRECT_REF
6294 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (fndecl
, 0)) == OBJ_TYPE_REF
)
6295 obj_type_ref
= TREE_OPERAND (fndecl
, 0);
6300 for (t
= TYPE_ARG_TYPES (type
); t
&& t
!= void_list_node
;
6302 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_VALUE (t
)) == REFERENCE_TYPE
6303 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (TREE_VALUE (t
))))
6305 if ((t
== NULL
|| t
== void_list_node
) && obj_type_ref
== NULL_TREE
)
6309 int nargs ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
= list_length (TYPE_ARG_TYPES (type
));
6310 link
= CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (insn
);
6311 #ifndef PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
6312 if (aggregate_value_p (TREE_TYPE (type
), type
)
6313 && targetm
.calls
.struct_value_rtx (type
, 0) == 0)
6315 tree struct_addr
= build_pointer_type (TREE_TYPE (type
));
6316 function_arg_info
arg (struct_addr
, /*named=*/true);
6318 INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (args_so_far_v
, type
, NULL_RTX
, fndecl
,
6320 reg
= targetm
.calls
.function_arg (args_so_far
, arg
);
6321 targetm
.calls
.function_arg_advance (args_so_far
, arg
);
6322 if (reg
== NULL_RTX
)
6324 for (; link
; link
= XEXP (link
, 1))
6325 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (link
, 0)) == USE
6326 && MEM_P (XEXP (XEXP (link
, 0), 0)))
6328 link
= XEXP (link
, 1);
6335 INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (args_so_far_v
, type
, NULL_RTX
, fndecl
,
6337 if (obj_type_ref
&& TYPE_ARG_TYPES (type
) != void_list_node
)
6339 t
= TYPE_ARG_TYPES (type
);
6340 function_arg_info
arg (TREE_VALUE (t
), /*named=*/true);
6341 this_arg
= targetm
.calls
.function_arg (args_so_far
, arg
);
6342 if (this_arg
&& !REG_P (this_arg
))
6343 this_arg
= NULL_RTX
;
6344 else if (this_arg
== NULL_RTX
)
6346 for (; link
; link
= XEXP (link
, 1))
6347 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (link
, 0)) == USE
6348 && MEM_P (XEXP (XEXP (link
, 0), 0)))
6350 this_arg
= XEXP (XEXP (link
, 0), 0);
6358 t
= type
? TYPE_ARG_TYPES (type
) : NULL_TREE
;
6360 for (link
= CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (insn
); link
; link
= XEXP (link
, 1))
6361 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (link
, 0)) == USE
)
6363 rtx item
= NULL_RTX
;
6364 x
= XEXP (XEXP (link
, 0), 0);
6365 if (GET_MODE (link
) == VOIDmode
6366 || GET_MODE (link
) == BLKmode
6367 || (GET_MODE (link
) != GET_MODE (x
)
6368 && ((GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (link
)) != MODE_INT
6369 && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (link
)) != MODE_PARTIAL_INT
)
6370 || (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (x
)) != MODE_INT
6371 && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (x
)) != MODE_PARTIAL_INT
))))
6372 /* Can't do anything for these, if the original type mode
6373 isn't known or can't be converted. */;
6376 cselib_val
*val
= cselib_lookup (x
, GET_MODE (x
), 0, VOIDmode
);
6377 scalar_int_mode mode
;
6378 if (val
&& cselib_preserved_value_p (val
))
6379 item
= val
->val_rtx
;
6380 else if (is_a
<scalar_int_mode
> (GET_MODE (x
), &mode
))
6382 opt_scalar_int_mode mode_iter
;
6383 FOR_EACH_WIDER_MODE (mode_iter
, mode
)
6385 mode
= mode_iter
.require ();
6386 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode
) > BITS_PER_WORD
)
6389 rtx reg
= simplify_subreg (mode
, x
, GET_MODE (x
), 0);
6390 if (reg
== NULL_RTX
|| !REG_P (reg
))
6392 val
= cselib_lookup (reg
, mode
, 0, VOIDmode
);
6393 if (val
&& cselib_preserved_value_p (val
))
6395 item
= val
->val_rtx
;
6406 if (!frame_pointer_needed
)
6408 class adjust_mem_data amd
;
6409 amd
.mem_mode
= VOIDmode
;
6410 amd
.stack_adjust
= -VTI (bb
)->out
.stack_adjust
;
6412 mem
= simplify_replace_fn_rtx (mem
, NULL_RTX
, adjust_mems
,
6414 gcc_assert (amd
.side_effects
.is_empty ());
6416 val
= cselib_lookup (mem
, GET_MODE (mem
), 0, VOIDmode
);
6417 if (val
&& cselib_preserved_value_p (val
))
6418 item
= val
->val_rtx
;
6419 else if (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (mem
)) != MODE_INT
6420 && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (mem
)) != MODE_PARTIAL_INT
)
6422 /* For non-integer stack argument see also if they weren't
6423 initialized by integers. */
6424 scalar_int_mode imode
;
6425 if (int_mode_for_mode (GET_MODE (mem
)).exists (&imode
)
6426 && imode
!= GET_MODE (mem
))
6428 val
= cselib_lookup (adjust_address_nv (mem
, imode
, 0),
6429 imode
, 0, VOIDmode
);
6430 if (val
&& cselib_preserved_value_p (val
))
6431 item
= lowpart_subreg (GET_MODE (x
), val
->val_rtx
,
6439 if (GET_MODE (item
) != GET_MODE (link
))
6440 item
= lowpart_subreg (GET_MODE (link
), item
, GET_MODE (item
));
6441 if (GET_MODE (x2
) != GET_MODE (link
))
6442 x2
= lowpart_subreg (GET_MODE (link
), x2
, GET_MODE (x2
));
6443 item
= gen_rtx_CONCAT (GET_MODE (link
), x2
, item
);
6445 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode
, item
, call_arguments
);
6447 if (t
&& t
!= void_list_node
)
6450 function_arg_info
arg (TREE_VALUE (t
), /*named=*/true);
6451 apply_pass_by_reference_rules (&args_so_far_v
, arg
);
6452 reg
= targetm
.calls
.function_arg (args_so_far
, arg
);
6453 if (TREE_CODE (arg
.type
) == REFERENCE_TYPE
6454 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (arg
.type
))
6457 && GET_MODE (reg
) == arg
.mode
6458 && (GET_MODE_CLASS (arg
.mode
) == MODE_INT
6459 || GET_MODE_CLASS (arg
.mode
) == MODE_PARTIAL_INT
)
6461 && REGNO (x
) == REGNO (reg
)
6462 && GET_MODE (x
) == arg
.mode
6465 machine_mode indmode
6466 = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (arg
.type
));
6467 rtx mem
= gen_rtx_MEM (indmode
, x
);
6468 cselib_val
*val
= cselib_lookup (mem
, indmode
, 0, VOIDmode
);
6469 if (val
&& cselib_preserved_value_p (val
))
6471 item
= gen_rtx_CONCAT (indmode
, mem
, val
->val_rtx
);
6472 call_arguments
= gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode
, item
,
6477 struct elt_loc_list
*l
;
6480 /* Try harder, when passing address of a constant
6481 pool integer it can be easily read back. */
6482 item
= XEXP (item
, 1);
6483 if (GET_CODE (item
) == SUBREG
)
6484 item
= SUBREG_REG (item
);
6485 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (item
) == VALUE
);
6486 val
= CSELIB_VAL_PTR (item
);
6487 for (l
= val
->locs
; l
; l
= l
->next
)
6488 if (GET_CODE (l
->loc
) == SYMBOL_REF
6489 && TREE_CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (l
->loc
)
6490 && SYMBOL_REF_DECL (l
->loc
)
6491 && DECL_INITIAL (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (l
->loc
)))
6493 initial
= DECL_INITIAL (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (l
->loc
));
6494 if (tree_fits_shwi_p (initial
))
6496 item
= GEN_INT (tree_to_shwi (initial
));
6497 item
= gen_rtx_CONCAT (indmode
, mem
, item
);
6499 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode
, item
,
6506 targetm
.calls
.function_arg_advance (args_so_far
, arg
);
6511 /* Add debug arguments. */
6513 && TREE_CODE (fndecl
) == FUNCTION_DECL
6514 && DECL_HAS_DEBUG_ARGS_P (fndecl
))
6516 vec
<tree
, va_gc
> **debug_args
= decl_debug_args_lookup (fndecl
);
6521 for (ix
= 0; vec_safe_iterate (*debug_args
, ix
, ¶m
); ix
+= 2)
6524 tree dtemp
= (**debug_args
)[ix
+ 1];
6525 machine_mode mode
= DECL_MODE (dtemp
);
6526 item
= gen_rtx_DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF (mode
, param
);
6527 item
= gen_rtx_CONCAT (mode
, item
, DECL_RTL_KNOWN_SET (dtemp
));
6528 call_arguments
= gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode
, item
,
6534 /* Reverse call_arguments chain. */
6536 for (cur
= call_arguments
; cur
; cur
= next
)
6538 next
= XEXP (cur
, 1);
6539 XEXP (cur
, 1) = prev
;
6542 call_arguments
= prev
;
6544 x
= get_call_rtx_from (insn
);
6547 x
= XEXP (XEXP (x
, 0), 0);
6548 if (GET_CODE (x
) == SYMBOL_REF
)
6549 /* Don't record anything. */;
6550 else if (CONSTANT_P (x
))
6552 x
= gen_rtx_CONCAT (GET_MODE (x
) == VOIDmode
? Pmode
: GET_MODE (x
),
6555 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode
, x
, call_arguments
);
6559 cselib_val
*val
= cselib_lookup (x
, GET_MODE (x
), 0, VOIDmode
);
6560 if (val
&& cselib_preserved_value_p (val
))
6562 x
= gen_rtx_CONCAT (GET_MODE (x
), pc_rtx
, val
->val_rtx
);
6564 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode
, x
, call_arguments
);
6571 = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (OBJ_TYPE_REF_EXPR (obj_type_ref
)));
6572 rtx clobbered
= gen_rtx_MEM (mode
, this_arg
);
6574 = tree_to_shwi (OBJ_TYPE_REF_TOKEN (obj_type_ref
));
6576 clobbered
= plus_constant (mode
, clobbered
,
6577 token
* GET_MODE_SIZE (mode
));
6578 clobbered
= gen_rtx_MEM (mode
, clobbered
);
6579 x
= gen_rtx_CONCAT (mode
, gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode
, pc_rtx
), clobbered
);
6581 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode
, x
, call_arguments
);
6585 /* Callback for cselib_record_sets_hook, that records as micro
6586 operations uses and stores in an insn after cselib_record_sets has
6587 analyzed the sets in an insn, but before it modifies the stored
6588 values in the internal tables, unless cselib_record_sets doesn't
6589 call it directly (perhaps because we're not doing cselib in the
6590 first place, in which case sets and n_sets will be 0). */
6593 add_with_sets (rtx_insn
*insn
, struct cselib_set
*sets
, int n_sets
)
6595 basic_block bb
= BLOCK_FOR_INSN (insn
);
6597 struct count_use_info cui
;
6598 micro_operation
*mos
;
6600 cselib_hook_called
= true;
6605 cui
.n_sets
= n_sets
;
6607 n1
= VTI (bb
)->mos
.length ();
6608 cui
.store_p
= false;
6609 note_uses (&PATTERN (insn
), add_uses_1
, &cui
);
6610 n2
= VTI (bb
)->mos
.length () - 1;
6611 mos
= VTI (bb
)->mos
.address ();
6613 /* Order the MO_USEs to be before MO_USE_NO_VARs and MO_VAL_USE, and
6617 while (n1
< n2
&& mos
[n1
].type
== MO_USE
)
6619 while (n1
< n2
&& mos
[n2
].type
!= MO_USE
)
6622 std::swap (mos
[n1
], mos
[n2
]);
6625 n2
= VTI (bb
)->mos
.length () - 1;
6628 while (n1
< n2
&& mos
[n1
].type
!= MO_VAL_LOC
)
6630 while (n1
< n2
&& mos
[n2
].type
== MO_VAL_LOC
)
6633 std::swap (mos
[n1
], mos
[n2
]);
6642 mo
.u
.loc
= call_arguments
;
6643 call_arguments
= NULL_RTX
;
6645 if (dump_file
&& (dump_flags
& TDF_DETAILS
))
6646 log_op_type (PATTERN (insn
), bb
, insn
, mo
.type
, dump_file
);
6647 VTI (bb
)->mos
.safe_push (mo
);
6650 n1
= VTI (bb
)->mos
.length ();
6651 /* This will record NEXT_INSN (insn), such that we can
6652 insert notes before it without worrying about any
6653 notes that MO_USEs might emit after the insn. */
6655 note_stores (insn
, add_stores
, &cui
);
6656 n2
= VTI (bb
)->mos
.length () - 1;
6657 mos
= VTI (bb
)->mos
.address ();
6659 /* Order the MO_VAL_USEs first (note_stores does nothing
6660 on DEBUG_INSNs, so there are no MO_VAL_LOCs from this
6661 insn), then MO_CLOBBERs, then MO_SET/MO_COPY/MO_VAL_SET. */
6664 while (n1
< n2
&& mos
[n1
].type
== MO_VAL_USE
)
6666 while (n1
< n2
&& mos
[n2
].type
!= MO_VAL_USE
)
6669 std::swap (mos
[n1
], mos
[n2
]);
6672 n2
= VTI (bb
)->mos
.length () - 1;
6675 while (n1
< n2
&& mos
[n1
].type
== MO_CLOBBER
)
6677 while (n1
< n2
&& mos
[n2
].type
!= MO_CLOBBER
)
6680 std::swap (mos
[n1
], mos
[n2
]);
6684 static enum var_init_status
6685 find_src_status (dataflow_set
*in
, rtx src
)
6687 tree decl
= NULL_TREE
;
6688 enum var_init_status status
= VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED
;
6690 if (! flag_var_tracking_uninit
)
6691 status
= VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
;
6693 if (src
&& REG_P (src
))
6694 decl
= var_debug_decl (REG_EXPR (src
));
6695 else if (src
&& MEM_P (src
))
6696 decl
= var_debug_decl (MEM_EXPR (src
));
6699 status
= get_init_value (in
, src
, dv_from_decl (decl
));
6704 /* SRC is the source of an assignment. Use SET to try to find what
6705 was ultimately assigned to SRC. Return that value if known,
6706 otherwise return SRC itself. */
6709 find_src_set_src (dataflow_set
*set
, rtx src
)
6711 tree decl
= NULL_TREE
; /* The variable being copied around. */
6712 rtx set_src
= NULL_RTX
; /* The value for "decl" stored in "src". */
6714 location_chain
*nextp
;
6718 if (src
&& REG_P (src
))
6719 decl
= var_debug_decl (REG_EXPR (src
));
6720 else if (src
&& MEM_P (src
))
6721 decl
= var_debug_decl (MEM_EXPR (src
));
6725 decl_or_value dv
= dv_from_decl (decl
);
6727 var
= shared_hash_find (set
->vars
, dv
);
6731 for (i
= 0; i
< var
->n_var_parts
&& !found
; i
++)
6732 for (nextp
= var
->var_part
[i
].loc_chain
; nextp
&& !found
;
6733 nextp
= nextp
->next
)
6734 if (rtx_equal_p (nextp
->loc
, src
))
6736 set_src
= nextp
->set_src
;
6746 /* Compute the changes of variable locations in the basic block BB. */
6749 compute_bb_dataflow (basic_block bb
)
6752 micro_operation
*mo
;
6754 dataflow_set old_out
;
6755 dataflow_set
*in
= &VTI (bb
)->in
;
6756 dataflow_set
*out
= &VTI (bb
)->out
;
6758 dataflow_set_init (&old_out
);
6759 dataflow_set_copy (&old_out
, out
);
6760 dataflow_set_copy (out
, in
);
6762 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_BIND_INSNS
)
6763 local_get_addr_cache
= new hash_map
<rtx
, rtx
>;
6765 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (VTI (bb
)->mos
, i
, mo
)
6767 rtx_insn
*insn
= mo
->insn
;
6772 dataflow_set_clear_at_call (out
, insn
);
6777 rtx loc
= mo
->u
.loc
;
6780 var_reg_set (out
, loc
, VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED
, NULL
);
6781 else if (MEM_P (loc
))
6782 var_mem_set (out
, loc
, VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED
, NULL
);
6788 rtx loc
= mo
->u
.loc
;
6792 if (GET_CODE (loc
) == CONCAT
)
6794 val
= XEXP (loc
, 0);
6795 vloc
= XEXP (loc
, 1);
6803 var
= PAT_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (vloc
);
6805 clobber_variable_part (out
, NULL_RTX
,
6806 dv_from_decl (var
), 0, NULL_RTX
);
6809 if (VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION (loc
))
6810 val_resolve (out
, val
, PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (vloc
), insn
);
6811 set_variable_part (out
, val
, dv_from_decl (var
), 0,
6812 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
, NULL_RTX
,
6815 else if (!VAR_LOC_UNKNOWN_P (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (vloc
)))
6816 set_variable_part (out
, PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (vloc
),
6817 dv_from_decl (var
), 0,
6818 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
, NULL_RTX
,
6825 rtx loc
= mo
->u
.loc
;
6826 rtx val
, vloc
, uloc
;
6828 vloc
= uloc
= XEXP (loc
, 1);
6829 val
= XEXP (loc
, 0);
6831 if (GET_CODE (val
) == CONCAT
)
6833 uloc
= XEXP (val
, 1);
6834 val
= XEXP (val
, 0);
6837 if (VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION (loc
))
6838 val_resolve (out
, val
, vloc
, insn
);
6840 val_store (out
, val
, uloc
, insn
, false);
6842 if (VAL_HOLDS_TRACK_EXPR (loc
))
6844 if (GET_CODE (uloc
) == REG
)
6845 var_reg_set (out
, uloc
, VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED
,
6847 else if (GET_CODE (uloc
) == MEM
)
6848 var_mem_set (out
, uloc
, VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED
,
6856 rtx loc
= mo
->u
.loc
;
6857 rtx val
, vloc
, uloc
;
6861 uloc
= XEXP (vloc
, 1);
6862 val
= XEXP (vloc
, 0);
6865 if (GET_CODE (uloc
) == SET
)
6867 dstv
= SET_DEST (uloc
);
6868 srcv
= SET_SRC (uloc
);
6876 if (GET_CODE (val
) == CONCAT
)
6878 dstv
= vloc
= XEXP (val
, 1);
6879 val
= XEXP (val
, 0);
6882 if (GET_CODE (vloc
) == SET
)
6884 srcv
= SET_SRC (vloc
);
6886 gcc_assert (val
!= srcv
);
6887 gcc_assert (vloc
== uloc
|| VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION (loc
));
6889 dstv
= vloc
= SET_DEST (vloc
);
6891 if (VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION (loc
))
6892 val_resolve (out
, val
, srcv
, insn
);
6894 else if (VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION (loc
))
6896 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (uloc
) == SET
6897 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (uloc
)) == REG
);
6898 val_resolve (out
, val
, SET_SRC (uloc
), insn
);
6901 if (VAL_HOLDS_TRACK_EXPR (loc
))
6903 if (VAL_EXPR_IS_CLOBBERED (loc
))
6906 var_reg_delete (out
, uloc
, true);
6907 else if (MEM_P (uloc
))
6909 gcc_assert (MEM_P (dstv
));
6910 gcc_assert (MEM_ATTRS (dstv
) == MEM_ATTRS (uloc
));
6911 var_mem_delete (out
, dstv
, true);
6916 bool copied_p
= VAL_EXPR_IS_COPIED (loc
);
6917 rtx src
= NULL
, dst
= uloc
;
6918 enum var_init_status status
= VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
;
6920 if (GET_CODE (uloc
) == SET
)
6922 src
= SET_SRC (uloc
);
6923 dst
= SET_DEST (uloc
);
6928 if (flag_var_tracking_uninit
)
6930 status
= find_src_status (in
, src
);
6932 if (status
== VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNKNOWN
)
6933 status
= find_src_status (out
, src
);
6936 src
= find_src_set_src (in
, src
);
6940 var_reg_delete_and_set (out
, dst
, !copied_p
,
6942 else if (MEM_P (dst
))
6944 gcc_assert (MEM_P (dstv
));
6945 gcc_assert (MEM_ATTRS (dstv
) == MEM_ATTRS (dst
));
6946 var_mem_delete_and_set (out
, dstv
, !copied_p
,
6951 else if (REG_P (uloc
))
6952 var_regno_delete (out
, REGNO (uloc
));
6953 else if (MEM_P (uloc
))
6955 gcc_checking_assert (GET_CODE (vloc
) == MEM
);
6956 gcc_checking_assert (dstv
== vloc
);
6958 clobber_overlapping_mems (out
, vloc
);
6961 val_store (out
, val
, dstv
, insn
, true);
6967 rtx loc
= mo
->u
.loc
;
6970 if (GET_CODE (loc
) == SET
)
6972 set_src
= SET_SRC (loc
);
6973 loc
= SET_DEST (loc
);
6977 var_reg_delete_and_set (out
, loc
, true, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
,
6979 else if (MEM_P (loc
))
6980 var_mem_delete_and_set (out
, loc
, true, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
,
6987 rtx loc
= mo
->u
.loc
;
6988 enum var_init_status src_status
;
6991 if (GET_CODE (loc
) == SET
)
6993 set_src
= SET_SRC (loc
);
6994 loc
= SET_DEST (loc
);
6997 if (! flag_var_tracking_uninit
)
6998 src_status
= VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
;
7001 src_status
= find_src_status (in
, set_src
);
7003 if (src_status
== VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNKNOWN
)
7004 src_status
= find_src_status (out
, set_src
);
7007 set_src
= find_src_set_src (in
, set_src
);
7010 var_reg_delete_and_set (out
, loc
, false, src_status
, set_src
);
7011 else if (MEM_P (loc
))
7012 var_mem_delete_and_set (out
, loc
, false, src_status
, set_src
);
7018 rtx loc
= mo
->u
.loc
;
7021 var_reg_delete (out
, loc
, false);
7022 else if (MEM_P (loc
))
7023 var_mem_delete (out
, loc
, false);
7029 rtx loc
= mo
->u
.loc
;
7032 var_reg_delete (out
, loc
, true);
7033 else if (MEM_P (loc
))
7034 var_mem_delete (out
, loc
, true);
7039 out
->stack_adjust
+= mo
->u
.adjust
;
7044 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_BIND_INSNS
)
7046 delete local_get_addr_cache
;
7047 local_get_addr_cache
= NULL
;
7049 dataflow_set_equiv_regs (out
);
7050 shared_hash_htab (out
->vars
)
7051 ->traverse
<dataflow_set
*, canonicalize_values_mark
> (out
);
7052 shared_hash_htab (out
->vars
)
7053 ->traverse
<dataflow_set
*, canonicalize_values_star
> (out
);
7055 shared_hash_htab (out
->vars
)
7056 ->traverse
<dataflow_set
*, canonicalize_loc_order_check
> (out
);
7058 changed
= dataflow_set_different (&old_out
, out
);
7059 dataflow_set_destroy (&old_out
);
7063 /* Find the locations of variables in the whole function. */
7066 vt_find_locations (void)
7068 bb_heap_t
*worklist
= new bb_heap_t (LONG_MIN
);
7069 bb_heap_t
*pending
= new bb_heap_t (LONG_MIN
);
7070 sbitmap in_worklist
, in_pending
;
7077 int htabmax
= param_max_vartrack_size
;
7078 bool success
= true;
7079 unsigned int n_blocks_processed
= 0;
7081 timevar_push (TV_VAR_TRACKING_DATAFLOW
);
7082 /* Compute reverse completion order of depth first search of the CFG
7083 so that the data-flow runs faster. */
7084 rc_order
= XNEWVEC (int, n_basic_blocks_for_fn (cfun
) - NUM_FIXED_BLOCKS
);
7085 bb_order
= XNEWVEC (int, last_basic_block_for_fn (cfun
));
7086 auto_bitmap exit_bbs
;
7087 bitmap_set_bit (exit_bbs
, EXIT_BLOCK
);
7088 auto_vec
<std::pair
<int, int> > toplevel_scc_extents
;
7089 int n
= rev_post_order_and_mark_dfs_back_seme
7090 (cfun
, single_succ_edge (ENTRY_BLOCK_PTR_FOR_FN (cfun
)), exit_bbs
, true,
7091 rc_order
, &toplevel_scc_extents
);
7092 for (i
= 0; i
< n
; i
++)
7093 bb_order
[rc_order
[i
]] = i
;
7095 in_worklist
= sbitmap_alloc (last_basic_block_for_fn (cfun
));
7096 in_pending
= sbitmap_alloc (last_basic_block_for_fn (cfun
));
7097 bitmap_clear (in_worklist
);
7098 bitmap_clear (in_pending
);
7100 /* We're performing the dataflow iteration independently over the
7101 toplevel SCCs plus leading non-cyclic entry blocks and separately
7102 over the tail. That ensures best memory locality and the least
7103 number of visited blocks. */
7104 unsigned extent
= 0;
7105 int curr_start
= -1;
7109 curr_start
= curr_end
+ 1;
7110 if (toplevel_scc_extents
.length () <= extent
)
7113 curr_end
= toplevel_scc_extents
[extent
++].second
;
7115 for (int i
= curr_start
; i
<= curr_end
; ++i
)
7117 pending
->insert (i
, BASIC_BLOCK_FOR_FN (cfun
, rc_order
[i
]));
7118 bitmap_set_bit (in_pending
, rc_order
[i
]);
7121 while (success
&& !pending
->empty ())
7123 std::swap (worklist
, pending
);
7124 std::swap (in_worklist
, in_pending
);
7126 while (!worklist
->empty ())
7130 int oldinsz
, oldoutsz
;
7132 bb
= worklist
->extract_min ();
7133 bitmap_clear_bit (in_worklist
, bb
->index
);
7135 if (VTI (bb
)->in
.vars
)
7137 htabsz
-= (shared_hash_htab (VTI (bb
)->in
.vars
)->size ()
7138 + shared_hash_htab (VTI (bb
)->out
.vars
)->size ());
7139 oldinsz
= shared_hash_htab (VTI (bb
)->in
.vars
)->elements ();
7140 oldoutsz
= shared_hash_htab (VTI (bb
)->out
.vars
)->elements ();
7143 oldinsz
= oldoutsz
= 0;
7145 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_BIND_INSNS
)
7147 dataflow_set
*in
= &VTI (bb
)->in
, *first_out
= NULL
;
7148 bool first
= true, adjust
= false;
7150 /* Calculate the IN set as the intersection of
7151 predecessor OUT sets. */
7153 dataflow_set_clear (in
);
7154 dst_can_be_shared
= true;
7156 FOR_EACH_EDGE (e
, ei
, bb
->preds
)
7157 if (!VTI (e
->src
)->flooded
)
7158 gcc_assert (bb_order
[bb
->index
]
7159 <= bb_order
[e
->src
->index
]);
7162 dataflow_set_copy (in
, &VTI (e
->src
)->out
);
7163 first_out
= &VTI (e
->src
)->out
;
7168 dataflow_set_merge (in
, &VTI (e
->src
)->out
);
7174 dataflow_post_merge_adjust (in
, &VTI (bb
)->permp
);
7177 /* Merge and merge_adjust should keep entries in
7179 shared_hash_htab (in
->vars
)
7180 ->traverse
<dataflow_set
*,
7181 canonicalize_loc_order_check
> (in
);
7183 if (dst_can_be_shared
)
7185 shared_hash_destroy (in
->vars
);
7186 in
->vars
= shared_hash_copy (first_out
->vars
);
7190 VTI (bb
)->flooded
= true;
7194 /* Calculate the IN set as union of predecessor OUT sets. */
7195 dataflow_set_clear (&VTI (bb
)->in
);
7196 FOR_EACH_EDGE (e
, ei
, bb
->preds
)
7197 dataflow_set_union (&VTI (bb
)->in
, &VTI (e
->src
)->out
);
7200 changed
= compute_bb_dataflow (bb
);
7201 n_blocks_processed
++;
7202 htabsz
+= (shared_hash_htab (VTI (bb
)->in
.vars
)->size ()
7203 + shared_hash_htab (VTI (bb
)->out
.vars
)->size ());
7205 if (htabmax
&& htabsz
> htabmax
)
7207 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_BIND_INSNS
)
7208 inform (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (cfun
->decl
),
7209 "variable tracking size limit exceeded with "
7210 "%<-fvar-tracking-assignments%>, retrying without");
7212 inform (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (cfun
->decl
),
7213 "variable tracking size limit exceeded");
7220 FOR_EACH_EDGE (e
, ei
, bb
->succs
)
7222 if (e
->dest
== EXIT_BLOCK_PTR_FOR_FN (cfun
))
7225 /* Iterate to an earlier block in RPO in the next
7226 round, iterate to the same block immediately. */
7227 if (bb_order
[e
->dest
->index
] < bb_order
[bb
->index
])
7229 gcc_assert (bb_order
[e
->dest
->index
] >= curr_start
);
7230 if (!bitmap_bit_p (in_pending
, e
->dest
->index
))
7232 /* Send E->DEST to next round. */
7233 bitmap_set_bit (in_pending
, e
->dest
->index
);
7234 pending
->insert (bb_order
[e
->dest
->index
],
7238 else if (bb_order
[e
->dest
->index
] <= curr_end
7239 && !bitmap_bit_p (in_worklist
, e
->dest
->index
))
7241 /* Add E->DEST to current round or delay
7242 processing if it is in the next SCC. */
7243 bitmap_set_bit (in_worklist
, e
->dest
->index
);
7244 worklist
->insert (bb_order
[e
->dest
->index
],
7252 "BB %i: in %i (was %i), out %i (was %i), rem %i + %i, "
7253 "tsz %i\n", bb
->index
,
7254 (int)shared_hash_htab (VTI (bb
)->in
.vars
)->size (),
7256 (int)shared_hash_htab (VTI (bb
)->out
.vars
)->size (),
7258 (int)worklist
->nodes (), (int)pending
->nodes (),
7261 if (dump_file
&& (dump_flags
& TDF_DETAILS
))
7263 fprintf (dump_file
, "BB %i IN:\n", bb
->index
);
7264 dump_dataflow_set (&VTI (bb
)->in
);
7265 fprintf (dump_file
, "BB %i OUT:\n", bb
->index
);
7266 dump_dataflow_set (&VTI (bb
)->out
);
7271 while (curr_end
!= n
- 1);
7273 statistics_counter_event (cfun
, "compute_bb_dataflow times",
7274 n_blocks_processed
);
7276 if (success
&& MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_BIND_INSNS
)
7277 FOR_EACH_BB_FN (bb
, cfun
)
7278 gcc_assert (VTI (bb
)->flooded
);
7284 sbitmap_free (in_worklist
);
7285 sbitmap_free (in_pending
);
7287 timevar_pop (TV_VAR_TRACKING_DATAFLOW
);
7291 /* Print the content of the LIST to dump file. */
7294 dump_attrs_list (attrs
*list
)
7296 for (; list
; list
= list
->next
)
7298 if (dv_is_decl_p (list
->dv
))
7299 print_mem_expr (dump_file
, dv_as_decl (list
->dv
));
7301 print_rtl_single (dump_file
, dv_as_value (list
->dv
));
7302 fprintf (dump_file
, "+" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC
, list
->offset
);
7304 fprintf (dump_file
, "\n");
7307 /* Print the information about variable *SLOT to dump file. */
7310 dump_var_tracking_slot (variable
**slot
, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
)
7312 variable
*var
= *slot
;
7316 /* Continue traversing the hash table. */
7320 /* Print the information about variable VAR to dump file. */
7323 dump_var (variable
*var
)
7326 location_chain
*node
;
7328 if (dv_is_decl_p (var
->dv
))
7330 const_tree decl
= dv_as_decl (var
->dv
);
7332 if (DECL_NAME (decl
))
7334 fprintf (dump_file
, " name: %s",
7335 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (decl
)));
7336 if (dump_flags
& TDF_UID
)
7337 fprintf (dump_file
, "D.%u", DECL_UID (decl
));
7339 else if (TREE_CODE (decl
) == DEBUG_EXPR_DECL
)
7340 fprintf (dump_file
, " name: D#%u", DEBUG_TEMP_UID (decl
));
7342 fprintf (dump_file
, " name: D.%u", DECL_UID (decl
));
7343 fprintf (dump_file
, "\n");
7347 fputc (' ', dump_file
);
7348 print_rtl_single (dump_file
, dv_as_value (var
->dv
));
7351 for (i
= 0; i
< var
->n_var_parts
; i
++)
7353 fprintf (dump_file
, " offset %ld\n",
7354 (long)(var
->onepart
? 0 : VAR_PART_OFFSET (var
, i
)));
7355 for (node
= var
->var_part
[i
].loc_chain
; node
; node
= node
->next
)
7357 fprintf (dump_file
, " ");
7358 if (node
->init
== VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED
)
7359 fprintf (dump_file
, "[uninit]");
7360 print_rtl_single (dump_file
, node
->loc
);
7365 /* Print the information about variables from hash table VARS to dump file. */
7368 dump_vars (variable_table_type
*vars
)
7370 if (!vars
->is_empty ())
7372 fprintf (dump_file
, "Variables:\n");
7373 vars
->traverse
<void *, dump_var_tracking_slot
> (NULL
);
7377 /* Print the dataflow set SET to dump file. */
7380 dump_dataflow_set (dataflow_set
*set
)
7384 fprintf (dump_file
, "Stack adjustment: " HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC
"\n",
7386 for (i
= 0; i
< FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
; i
++)
7390 fprintf (dump_file
, "Reg %d:", i
);
7391 dump_attrs_list (set
->regs
[i
]);
7394 dump_vars (shared_hash_htab (set
->vars
));
7395 fprintf (dump_file
, "\n");
7398 /* Print the IN and OUT sets for each basic block to dump file. */
7401 dump_dataflow_sets (void)
7405 FOR_EACH_BB_FN (bb
, cfun
)
7407 fprintf (dump_file
, "\nBasic block %d:\n", bb
->index
);
7408 fprintf (dump_file
, "IN:\n");
7409 dump_dataflow_set (&VTI (bb
)->in
);
7410 fprintf (dump_file
, "OUT:\n");
7411 dump_dataflow_set (&VTI (bb
)->out
);
7415 /* Return the variable for DV in dropped_values, inserting one if
7416 requested with INSERT. */
7418 static inline variable
*
7419 variable_from_dropped (decl_or_value dv
, enum insert_option insert
)
7422 variable
*empty_var
;
7423 onepart_enum onepart
;
7425 slot
= dropped_values
->find_slot_with_hash (dv
, dv_htab_hash (dv
), insert
);
7433 gcc_checking_assert (insert
== INSERT
);
7435 onepart
= dv_onepart_p (dv
);
7437 gcc_checking_assert (onepart
== ONEPART_VALUE
|| onepart
== ONEPART_DEXPR
);
7439 empty_var
= onepart_pool_allocate (onepart
);
7441 empty_var
->refcount
= 1;
7442 empty_var
->n_var_parts
= 0;
7443 empty_var
->onepart
= onepart
;
7444 empty_var
->in_changed_variables
= false;
7445 empty_var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
= NULL
;
7446 empty_var
->var_part
[0].cur_loc
= NULL
;
7447 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (empty_var
) = NULL
;
7448 set_dv_changed (dv
, true);
7455 /* Recover the one-part aux from dropped_values. */
7457 static struct onepart_aux
*
7458 recover_dropped_1paux (variable
*var
)
7462 gcc_checking_assert (var
->onepart
);
7464 if (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
))
7465 return VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
);
7467 if (var
->onepart
== ONEPART_VDECL
)
7470 dvar
= variable_from_dropped (var
->dv
, NO_INSERT
);
7475 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
) = VAR_LOC_1PAUX (dvar
);
7476 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (dvar
) = NULL
;
7478 return VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
);
7481 /* Add variable VAR to the hash table of changed variables and
7482 if it has no locations delete it from SET's hash table. */
7485 variable_was_changed (variable
*var
, dataflow_set
*set
)
7487 hashval_t hash
= dv_htab_hash (var
->dv
);
7493 /* Remember this decl or VALUE has been added to changed_variables. */
7494 set_dv_changed (var
->dv
, true);
7496 slot
= changed_variables
->find_slot_with_hash (var
->dv
, hash
, INSERT
);
7500 variable
*old_var
= *slot
;
7501 gcc_assert (old_var
->in_changed_variables
);
7502 old_var
->in_changed_variables
= false;
7503 if (var
!= old_var
&& var
->onepart
)
7505 /* Restore the auxiliary info from an empty variable
7506 previously created for changed_variables, so it is
7508 gcc_checking_assert (!VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
));
7509 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
) = VAR_LOC_1PAUX (old_var
);
7510 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (old_var
) = NULL
;
7512 variable_htab_free (*slot
);
7515 if (set
&& var
->n_var_parts
== 0)
7517 onepart_enum onepart
= var
->onepart
;
7518 variable
*empty_var
= NULL
;
7519 variable
**dslot
= NULL
;
7521 if (onepart
== ONEPART_VALUE
|| onepart
== ONEPART_DEXPR
)
7523 dslot
= dropped_values
->find_slot_with_hash (var
->dv
,
7524 dv_htab_hash (var
->dv
),
7530 gcc_checking_assert (!empty_var
->in_changed_variables
);
7531 if (!VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
))
7533 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
) = VAR_LOC_1PAUX (empty_var
);
7534 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (empty_var
) = NULL
;
7537 gcc_checking_assert (!VAR_LOC_1PAUX (empty_var
));
7543 empty_var
= onepart_pool_allocate (onepart
);
7544 empty_var
->dv
= var
->dv
;
7545 empty_var
->refcount
= 1;
7546 empty_var
->n_var_parts
= 0;
7547 empty_var
->onepart
= onepart
;
7550 empty_var
->refcount
++;
7555 empty_var
->refcount
++;
7556 empty_var
->in_changed_variables
= true;
7560 empty_var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
= NULL
;
7561 empty_var
->var_part
[0].cur_loc
= NULL
;
7562 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (empty_var
) = VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
);
7563 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
) = NULL
;
7569 if (var
->onepart
&& !VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
))
7570 recover_dropped_1paux (var
);
7572 var
->in_changed_variables
= true;
7579 if (var
->n_var_parts
== 0)
7584 slot
= shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert (set
->vars
, var
->dv
);
7587 if (shared_hash_shared (set
->vars
))
7588 slot
= shared_hash_find_slot_unshare (&set
->vars
, var
->dv
,
7590 shared_hash_htab (set
->vars
)->clear_slot (slot
);
7596 /* Look for the index in VAR->var_part corresponding to OFFSET.
7597 Return -1 if not found. If INSERTION_POINT is non-NULL, the
7598 referenced int will be set to the index that the part has or should
7599 have, if it should be inserted. */
7602 find_variable_location_part (variable
*var
, HOST_WIDE_INT offset
,
7603 int *insertion_point
)
7612 if (insertion_point
)
7613 *insertion_point
= 0;
7615 return var
->n_var_parts
- 1;
7618 /* Find the location part. */
7620 high
= var
->n_var_parts
;
7623 pos
= (low
+ high
) / 2;
7624 if (VAR_PART_OFFSET (var
, pos
) < offset
)
7631 if (insertion_point
)
7632 *insertion_point
= pos
;
7634 if (pos
< var
->n_var_parts
&& VAR_PART_OFFSET (var
, pos
) == offset
)
7641 set_slot_part (dataflow_set
*set
, rtx loc
, variable
**slot
,
7642 decl_or_value dv
, HOST_WIDE_INT offset
,
7643 enum var_init_status initialized
, rtx set_src
)
7646 location_chain
*node
, *next
;
7647 location_chain
**nextp
;
7649 onepart_enum onepart
;
7654 onepart
= var
->onepart
;
7656 onepart
= dv_onepart_p (dv
);
7658 gcc_checking_assert (offset
== 0 || !onepart
);
7659 gcc_checking_assert (loc
!= dv_as_opaque (dv
));
7661 if (! flag_var_tracking_uninit
)
7662 initialized
= VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
;
7666 /* Create new variable information. */
7667 var
= onepart_pool_allocate (onepart
);
7670 var
->n_var_parts
= 1;
7671 var
->onepart
= onepart
;
7672 var
->in_changed_variables
= false;
7674 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
) = NULL
;
7676 VAR_PART_OFFSET (var
, 0) = offset
;
7677 var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
= NULL
;
7678 var
->var_part
[0].cur_loc
= NULL
;
7681 nextp
= &var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
;
7687 gcc_assert (dv_as_opaque (var
->dv
) == dv_as_opaque (dv
));
7691 if (GET_CODE (loc
) == VALUE
)
7693 for (nextp
= &var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
; (node
= *nextp
);
7694 nextp
= &node
->next
)
7695 if (GET_CODE (node
->loc
) == VALUE
)
7697 if (node
->loc
== loc
)
7702 if (canon_value_cmp (node
->loc
, loc
))
7710 else if (REG_P (node
->loc
) || MEM_P (node
->loc
))
7718 else if (REG_P (loc
))
7720 for (nextp
= &var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
; (node
= *nextp
);
7721 nextp
= &node
->next
)
7722 if (REG_P (node
->loc
))
7724 if (REGNO (node
->loc
) < REGNO (loc
))
7728 if (REGNO (node
->loc
) == REGNO (loc
))
7741 else if (MEM_P (loc
))
7743 for (nextp
= &var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
; (node
= *nextp
);
7744 nextp
= &node
->next
)
7745 if (REG_P (node
->loc
))
7747 else if (MEM_P (node
->loc
))
7749 if ((r
= loc_cmp (XEXP (node
->loc
, 0), XEXP (loc
, 0))) >= 0)
7761 for (nextp
= &var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
; (node
= *nextp
);
7762 nextp
= &node
->next
)
7763 if ((r
= loc_cmp (node
->loc
, loc
)) >= 0)
7771 if (shared_var_p (var
, set
->vars
))
7773 slot
= unshare_variable (set
, slot
, var
, initialized
);
7775 for (nextp
= &var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
; c
;
7776 nextp
= &(*nextp
)->next
)
7778 gcc_assert ((!node
&& !*nextp
) || node
->loc
== (*nextp
)->loc
);
7785 gcc_assert (dv_as_decl (var
->dv
) == dv_as_decl (dv
));
7787 pos
= find_variable_location_part (var
, offset
, &inspos
);
7791 node
= var
->var_part
[pos
].loc_chain
;
7794 && ((REG_P (node
->loc
) && REG_P (loc
)
7795 && REGNO (node
->loc
) == REGNO (loc
))
7796 || rtx_equal_p (node
->loc
, loc
)))
7798 /* LOC is in the beginning of the chain so we have nothing
7800 if (node
->init
< initialized
)
7801 node
->init
= initialized
;
7802 if (set_src
!= NULL
)
7803 node
->set_src
= set_src
;
7809 /* We have to make a copy of a shared variable. */
7810 if (shared_var_p (var
, set
->vars
))
7812 slot
= unshare_variable (set
, slot
, var
, initialized
);
7819 /* We have not found the location part, new one will be created. */
7821 /* We have to make a copy of the shared variable. */
7822 if (shared_var_p (var
, set
->vars
))
7824 slot
= unshare_variable (set
, slot
, var
, initialized
);
7828 /* We track only variables whose size is <= MAX_VAR_PARTS bytes
7829 thus there are at most MAX_VAR_PARTS different offsets. */
7830 gcc_assert (var
->n_var_parts
< MAX_VAR_PARTS
7831 && (!var
->n_var_parts
|| !onepart
));
7833 /* We have to move the elements of array starting at index
7834 inspos to the next position. */
7835 for (pos
= var
->n_var_parts
; pos
> inspos
; pos
--)
7836 var
->var_part
[pos
] = var
->var_part
[pos
- 1];
7839 gcc_checking_assert (!onepart
);
7840 VAR_PART_OFFSET (var
, pos
) = offset
;
7841 var
->var_part
[pos
].loc_chain
= NULL
;
7842 var
->var_part
[pos
].cur_loc
= NULL
;
7845 /* Delete the location from the list. */
7846 nextp
= &var
->var_part
[pos
].loc_chain
;
7847 for (node
= var
->var_part
[pos
].loc_chain
; node
; node
= next
)
7850 if ((REG_P (node
->loc
) && REG_P (loc
)
7851 && REGNO (node
->loc
) == REGNO (loc
))
7852 || rtx_equal_p (node
->loc
, loc
))
7854 /* Save these values, to assign to the new node, before
7855 deleting this one. */
7856 if (node
->init
> initialized
)
7857 initialized
= node
->init
;
7858 if (node
->set_src
!= NULL
&& set_src
== NULL
)
7859 set_src
= node
->set_src
;
7860 if (var
->var_part
[pos
].cur_loc
== node
->loc
)
7861 var
->var_part
[pos
].cur_loc
= NULL
;
7867 nextp
= &node
->next
;
7870 nextp
= &var
->var_part
[pos
].loc_chain
;
7873 /* Add the location to the beginning. */
7874 node
= new location_chain
;
7876 node
->init
= initialized
;
7877 node
->set_src
= set_src
;
7878 node
->next
= *nextp
;
7881 /* If no location was emitted do so. */
7882 if (var
->var_part
[pos
].cur_loc
== NULL
)
7883 variable_was_changed (var
, set
);
7888 /* Set the part of variable's location in the dataflow set SET. The
7889 variable part is specified by variable's declaration in DV and
7890 offset OFFSET and the part's location by LOC. IOPT should be
7891 NO_INSERT if the variable is known to be in SET already and the
7892 variable hash table must not be resized, and INSERT otherwise. */
7895 set_variable_part (dataflow_set
*set
, rtx loc
,
7896 decl_or_value dv
, HOST_WIDE_INT offset
,
7897 enum var_init_status initialized
, rtx set_src
,
7898 enum insert_option iopt
)
7902 if (iopt
== NO_INSERT
)
7903 slot
= shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert (set
->vars
, dv
);
7906 slot
= shared_hash_find_slot (set
->vars
, dv
);
7908 slot
= shared_hash_find_slot_unshare (&set
->vars
, dv
, iopt
);
7910 set_slot_part (set
, loc
, slot
, dv
, offset
, initialized
, set_src
);
7913 /* Remove all recorded register locations for the given variable part
7914 from dataflow set SET, except for those that are identical to loc.
7915 The variable part is specified by variable's declaration or value
7916 DV and offset OFFSET. */
7919 clobber_slot_part (dataflow_set
*set
, rtx loc
, variable
**slot
,
7920 HOST_WIDE_INT offset
, rtx set_src
)
7922 variable
*var
= *slot
;
7923 int pos
= find_variable_location_part (var
, offset
, NULL
);
7927 location_chain
*node
, *next
;
7929 /* Remove the register locations from the dataflow set. */
7930 next
= var
->var_part
[pos
].loc_chain
;
7931 for (node
= next
; node
; node
= next
)
7934 if (node
->loc
!= loc
7935 && (!flag_var_tracking_uninit
7938 || !rtx_equal_p (set_src
, node
->set_src
)))
7940 if (REG_P (node
->loc
))
7942 attrs
*anode
, *anext
;
7945 /* Remove the variable part from the register's
7946 list, but preserve any other variable parts
7947 that might be regarded as live in that same
7949 anextp
= &set
->regs
[REGNO (node
->loc
)];
7950 for (anode
= *anextp
; anode
; anode
= anext
)
7952 anext
= anode
->next
;
7953 if (dv_as_opaque (anode
->dv
) == dv_as_opaque (var
->dv
)
7954 && anode
->offset
== offset
)
7960 anextp
= &anode
->next
;
7964 slot
= delete_slot_part (set
, node
->loc
, slot
, offset
);
7972 /* Remove all recorded register locations for the given variable part
7973 from dataflow set SET, except for those that are identical to loc.
7974 The variable part is specified by variable's declaration or value
7975 DV and offset OFFSET. */
7978 clobber_variable_part (dataflow_set
*set
, rtx loc
, decl_or_value dv
,
7979 HOST_WIDE_INT offset
, rtx set_src
)
7983 if (!dv_as_opaque (dv
)
7984 || (!dv_is_value_p (dv
) && ! DECL_P (dv_as_decl (dv
))))
7987 slot
= shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert (set
->vars
, dv
);
7991 clobber_slot_part (set
, loc
, slot
, offset
, set_src
);
7994 /* Delete the part of variable's location from dataflow set SET. The
7995 variable part is specified by its SET->vars slot SLOT and offset
7996 OFFSET and the part's location by LOC. */
7999 delete_slot_part (dataflow_set
*set
, rtx loc
, variable
**slot
,
8000 HOST_WIDE_INT offset
)
8002 variable
*var
= *slot
;
8003 int pos
= find_variable_location_part (var
, offset
, NULL
);
8007 location_chain
*node
, *next
;
8008 location_chain
**nextp
;
8012 if (shared_var_p (var
, set
->vars
))
8014 /* If the variable contains the location part we have to
8015 make a copy of the variable. */
8016 for (node
= var
->var_part
[pos
].loc_chain
; node
;
8019 if ((REG_P (node
->loc
) && REG_P (loc
)
8020 && REGNO (node
->loc
) == REGNO (loc
))
8021 || rtx_equal_p (node
->loc
, loc
))
8023 slot
= unshare_variable (set
, slot
, var
,
8024 VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNKNOWN
);
8031 if (pos
== 0 && var
->onepart
&& VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
))
8032 cur_loc
= VAR_LOC_FROM (var
);
8034 cur_loc
= var
->var_part
[pos
].cur_loc
;
8036 /* Delete the location part. */
8038 nextp
= &var
->var_part
[pos
].loc_chain
;
8039 for (node
= *nextp
; node
; node
= next
)
8042 if ((REG_P (node
->loc
) && REG_P (loc
)
8043 && REGNO (node
->loc
) == REGNO (loc
))
8044 || rtx_equal_p (node
->loc
, loc
))
8046 /* If we have deleted the location which was last emitted
8047 we have to emit new location so add the variable to set
8048 of changed variables. */
8049 if (cur_loc
== node
->loc
)
8052 var
->var_part
[pos
].cur_loc
= NULL
;
8053 if (pos
== 0 && var
->onepart
&& VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
))
8054 VAR_LOC_FROM (var
) = NULL
;
8061 nextp
= &node
->next
;
8064 if (var
->var_part
[pos
].loc_chain
== NULL
)
8068 while (pos
< var
->n_var_parts
)
8070 var
->var_part
[pos
] = var
->var_part
[pos
+ 1];
8075 variable_was_changed (var
, set
);
8081 /* Delete the part of variable's location from dataflow set SET. The
8082 variable part is specified by variable's declaration or value DV
8083 and offset OFFSET and the part's location by LOC. */
8086 delete_variable_part (dataflow_set
*set
, rtx loc
, decl_or_value dv
,
8087 HOST_WIDE_INT offset
)
8089 variable
**slot
= shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert (set
->vars
, dv
);
8093 delete_slot_part (set
, loc
, slot
, offset
);
8097 /* Structure for passing some other parameters to function
8098 vt_expand_loc_callback. */
8099 class expand_loc_callback_data
8102 /* The variables and values active at this point. */
8103 variable_table_type
*vars
;
8105 /* Stack of values and debug_exprs under expansion, and their
8107 auto_vec
<rtx
, 4> expanding
;
8109 /* Stack of values and debug_exprs whose expansion hit recursion
8110 cycles. They will have VALUE_RECURSED_INTO marked when added to
8111 this list. This flag will be cleared if any of its dependencies
8112 resolves to a valid location. So, if the flag remains set at the
8113 end of the search, we know no valid location for this one can
8115 auto_vec
<rtx
, 4> pending
;
8117 /* The maximum depth among the sub-expressions under expansion.
8118 Zero indicates no expansion so far. */
8122 /* Allocate the one-part auxiliary data structure for VAR, with enough
8123 room for COUNT dependencies. */
8126 loc_exp_dep_alloc (variable
*var
, int count
)
8130 gcc_checking_assert (var
->onepart
);
8132 /* We can be called with COUNT == 0 to allocate the data structure
8133 without any dependencies, e.g. for the backlinks only. However,
8134 if we are specifying a COUNT, then the dependency list must have
8135 been emptied before. It would be possible to adjust pointers or
8136 force it empty here, but this is better done at an earlier point
8137 in the algorithm, so we instead leave an assertion to catch
8139 gcc_checking_assert (!count
8140 || VAR_LOC_DEP_VEC (var
) == NULL
8141 || VAR_LOC_DEP_VEC (var
)->is_empty ());
8143 if (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
) && VAR_LOC_DEP_VEC (var
)->space (count
))
8146 allocsize
= offsetof (struct onepart_aux
, deps
)
8147 + deps_vec::embedded_size (count
);
8149 if (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
))
8151 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
) = XRESIZEVAR (struct onepart_aux
,
8152 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
), allocsize
);
8153 /* If the reallocation moves the onepaux structure, the
8154 back-pointer to BACKLINKS in the first list member will still
8155 point to its old location. Adjust it. */
8156 if (VAR_LOC_DEP_LST (var
))
8157 VAR_LOC_DEP_LST (var
)->pprev
= VAR_LOC_DEP_LSTP (var
);
8161 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
) = XNEWVAR (struct onepart_aux
, allocsize
);
8162 *VAR_LOC_DEP_LSTP (var
) = NULL
;
8163 VAR_LOC_FROM (var
) = NULL
;
8164 VAR_LOC_DEPTH (var
).complexity
= 0;
8165 VAR_LOC_DEPTH (var
).entryvals
= 0;
8167 VAR_LOC_DEP_VEC (var
)->embedded_init (count
);
8170 /* Remove all entries from the vector of active dependencies of VAR,
8171 removing them from the back-links lists too. */
8174 loc_exp_dep_clear (variable
*var
)
8176 while (VAR_LOC_DEP_VEC (var
) && !VAR_LOC_DEP_VEC (var
)->is_empty ())
8178 loc_exp_dep
*led
= &VAR_LOC_DEP_VEC (var
)->last ();
8180 led
->next
->pprev
= led
->pprev
;
8182 *led
->pprev
= led
->next
;
8183 VAR_LOC_DEP_VEC (var
)->pop ();
8187 /* Insert an active dependency from VAR on X to the vector of
8188 dependencies, and add the corresponding back-link to X's list of
8189 back-links in VARS. */
8192 loc_exp_insert_dep (variable
*var
, rtx x
, variable_table_type
*vars
)
8198 dv
= dv_from_rtx (x
);
8200 /* ??? Build a vector of variables parallel to EXPANDING, to avoid
8201 an additional look up? */
8202 xvar
= vars
->find_with_hash (dv
, dv_htab_hash (dv
));
8206 xvar
= variable_from_dropped (dv
, NO_INSERT
);
8207 gcc_checking_assert (xvar
);
8210 /* No point in adding the same backlink more than once. This may
8211 arise if say the same value appears in two complex expressions in
8212 the same loc_list, or even more than once in a single
8214 if (VAR_LOC_DEP_LST (xvar
) && VAR_LOC_DEP_LST (xvar
)->dv
== var
->dv
)
8217 if (var
->onepart
== NOT_ONEPART
)
8218 led
= new loc_exp_dep
;
8222 memset (&empty
, 0, sizeof (empty
));
8223 VAR_LOC_DEP_VEC (var
)->quick_push (empty
);
8224 led
= &VAR_LOC_DEP_VEC (var
)->last ();
8229 loc_exp_dep_alloc (xvar
, 0);
8230 led
->pprev
= VAR_LOC_DEP_LSTP (xvar
);
8231 led
->next
= *led
->pprev
;
8233 led
->next
->pprev
= &led
->next
;
8237 /* Create active dependencies of VAR on COUNT values starting at
8238 VALUE, and corresponding back-links to the entries in VARS. Return
8239 true if we found any pending-recursion results. */
8242 loc_exp_dep_set (variable
*var
, rtx result
, rtx
*value
, int count
,
8243 variable_table_type
*vars
)
8245 bool pending_recursion
= false;
8247 gcc_checking_assert (VAR_LOC_DEP_VEC (var
) == NULL
8248 || VAR_LOC_DEP_VEC (var
)->is_empty ());
8250 /* Set up all dependencies from last_child (as set up at the end of
8251 the loop above) to the end. */
8252 loc_exp_dep_alloc (var
, count
);
8258 if (!pending_recursion
)
8259 pending_recursion
= !result
&& VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (x
);
8261 loc_exp_insert_dep (var
, x
, vars
);
8264 return pending_recursion
;
8267 /* Notify the back-links of IVAR that are pending recursion that we
8268 have found a non-NIL value for it, so they are cleared for another
8269 attempt to compute a current location. */
8272 notify_dependents_of_resolved_value (variable
*ivar
, variable_table_type
*vars
)
8274 loc_exp_dep
*led
, *next
;
8276 for (led
= VAR_LOC_DEP_LST (ivar
); led
; led
= next
)
8278 decl_or_value dv
= led
->dv
;
8283 if (dv_is_value_p (dv
))
8285 rtx value
= dv_as_value (dv
);
8287 /* If we have already resolved it, leave it alone. */
8288 if (!VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (value
))
8291 /* Check that VALUE_RECURSED_INTO, true from the test above,
8292 implies NO_LOC_P. */
8293 gcc_checking_assert (NO_LOC_P (value
));
8295 /* We won't notify variables that are being expanded,
8296 because their dependency list is cleared before
8298 NO_LOC_P (value
) = false;
8299 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (value
) = false;
8301 gcc_checking_assert (dv_changed_p (dv
));
8305 gcc_checking_assert (dv_onepart_p (dv
) != NOT_ONEPART
);
8306 if (!dv_changed_p (dv
))
8310 var
= vars
->find_with_hash (dv
, dv_htab_hash (dv
));
8313 var
= variable_from_dropped (dv
, NO_INSERT
);
8316 notify_dependents_of_resolved_value (var
, vars
);
8319 next
->pprev
= led
->pprev
;
8327 static rtx
vt_expand_loc_callback (rtx x
, bitmap regs
,
8328 int max_depth
, void *data
);
8330 /* Return the combined depth, when one sub-expression evaluated to
8331 BEST_DEPTH and the previous known depth was SAVED_DEPTH. */
8333 static inline expand_depth
8334 update_depth (expand_depth saved_depth
, expand_depth best_depth
)
8336 /* If we didn't find anything, stick with what we had. */
8337 if (!best_depth
.complexity
)
8340 /* If we found hadn't found anything, use the depth of the current
8341 expression. Do NOT add one extra level, we want to compute the
8342 maximum depth among sub-expressions. We'll increment it later,
8344 if (!saved_depth
.complexity
)
8347 /* Combine the entryval count so that regardless of which one we
8348 return, the entryval count is accurate. */
8349 best_depth
.entryvals
= saved_depth
.entryvals
8350 = best_depth
.entryvals
+ saved_depth
.entryvals
;
8352 if (saved_depth
.complexity
< best_depth
.complexity
)
8358 /* Expand VAR to a location RTX, updating its cur_loc. Use REGS and
8359 DATA for cselib expand callback. If PENDRECP is given, indicate in
8360 it whether any sub-expression couldn't be fully evaluated because
8361 it is pending recursion resolution. */
8364 vt_expand_var_loc_chain (variable
*var
, bitmap regs
, void *data
,
8367 class expand_loc_callback_data
*elcd
8368 = (class expand_loc_callback_data
*) data
;
8369 location_chain
*loc
, *next
;
8371 int first_child
, result_first_child
, last_child
;
8372 bool pending_recursion
;
8373 rtx loc_from
= NULL
;
8374 struct elt_loc_list
*cloc
= NULL
;
8375 expand_depth depth
= { 0, 0 }, saved_depth
= elcd
->depth
;
8376 int wanted_entryvals
, found_entryvals
= 0;
8378 /* Clear all backlinks pointing at this, so that we're not notified
8379 while we're active. */
8380 loc_exp_dep_clear (var
);
8383 if (var
->onepart
== ONEPART_VALUE
)
8385 cselib_val
*val
= CSELIB_VAL_PTR (dv_as_value (var
->dv
));
8387 gcc_checking_assert (cselib_preserved_value_p (val
));
8392 first_child
= result_first_child
= last_child
8393 = elcd
->expanding
.length ();
8395 wanted_entryvals
= found_entryvals
;
8397 /* Attempt to expand each available location in turn. */
8398 for (next
= loc
= var
->n_var_parts
? var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
: NULL
;
8399 loc
|| cloc
; loc
= next
)
8401 result_first_child
= last_child
;
8405 loc_from
= cloc
->loc
;
8408 if (unsuitable_loc (loc_from
))
8413 loc_from
= loc
->loc
;
8417 gcc_checking_assert (!unsuitable_loc (loc_from
));
8419 elcd
->depth
.complexity
= elcd
->depth
.entryvals
= 0;
8420 result
= cselib_expand_value_rtx_cb (loc_from
, regs
, EXPR_DEPTH
,
8421 vt_expand_loc_callback
, data
);
8422 last_child
= elcd
->expanding
.length ();
8426 depth
= elcd
->depth
;
8428 gcc_checking_assert (depth
.complexity
8429 || result_first_child
== last_child
);
8431 if (last_child
- result_first_child
!= 1)
8433 if (!depth
.complexity
&& GET_CODE (result
) == ENTRY_VALUE
)
8438 if (depth
.complexity
<= EXPR_USE_DEPTH
)
8440 if (depth
.entryvals
<= wanted_entryvals
)
8442 else if (!found_entryvals
|| depth
.entryvals
< found_entryvals
)
8443 found_entryvals
= depth
.entryvals
;
8449 /* Set it up in case we leave the loop. */
8450 depth
.complexity
= depth
.entryvals
= 0;
8452 result_first_child
= first_child
;
8455 if (!loc_from
&& wanted_entryvals
< found_entryvals
)
8457 /* We found entries with ENTRY_VALUEs and skipped them. Since
8458 we could not find any expansions without ENTRY_VALUEs, but we
8459 found at least one with them, go back and get an entry with
8460 the minimum number ENTRY_VALUE count that we found. We could
8461 avoid looping, but since each sub-loc is already resolved,
8462 the re-expansion should be trivial. ??? Should we record all
8463 attempted locs as dependencies, so that we retry the
8464 expansion should any of them change, in the hope it can give
8465 us a new entry without an ENTRY_VALUE? */
8466 elcd
->expanding
.truncate (first_child
);
8470 /* Register all encountered dependencies as active. */
8471 pending_recursion
= loc_exp_dep_set
8472 (var
, result
, elcd
->expanding
.address () + result_first_child
,
8473 last_child
- result_first_child
, elcd
->vars
);
8475 elcd
->expanding
.truncate (first_child
);
8477 /* Record where the expansion came from. */
8478 gcc_checking_assert (!result
|| !pending_recursion
);
8479 VAR_LOC_FROM (var
) = loc_from
;
8480 VAR_LOC_DEPTH (var
) = depth
;
8482 gcc_checking_assert (!depth
.complexity
== !result
);
8484 elcd
->depth
= update_depth (saved_depth
, depth
);
8486 /* Indicate whether any of the dependencies are pending recursion
8489 *pendrecp
= pending_recursion
;
8491 if (!pendrecp
|| !pending_recursion
)
8492 var
->var_part
[0].cur_loc
= result
;
8497 /* Callback for cselib_expand_value, that looks for expressions
8498 holding the value in the var-tracking hash tables. Return X for
8499 standard processing, anything else is to be used as-is. */
8502 vt_expand_loc_callback (rtx x
, bitmap regs
,
8503 int max_depth ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
,
8506 class expand_loc_callback_data
*elcd
8507 = (class expand_loc_callback_data
*) data
;
8511 bool pending_recursion
= false;
8512 bool from_empty
= false;
8514 switch (GET_CODE (x
))
8517 subreg
= cselib_expand_value_rtx_cb (SUBREG_REG (x
), regs
,
8519 vt_expand_loc_callback
, data
);
8524 result
= simplify_gen_subreg (GET_MODE (x
), subreg
,
8525 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x
)),
8528 /* Invalid SUBREGs are ok in debug info. ??? We could try
8529 alternate expansions for the VALUE as well. */
8530 if (!result
&& GET_MODE (subreg
) != VOIDmode
)
8531 result
= gen_rtx_raw_SUBREG (GET_MODE (x
), subreg
, SUBREG_BYTE (x
));
8537 dv
= dv_from_rtx (x
);
8544 elcd
->expanding
.safe_push (x
);
8546 /* Check that VALUE_RECURSED_INTO implies NO_LOC_P. */
8547 gcc_checking_assert (!VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (x
) || NO_LOC_P (x
));
8551 gcc_checking_assert (VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (x
) || !dv_changed_p (dv
));
8555 var
= elcd
->vars
->find_with_hash (dv
, dv_htab_hash (dv
));
8560 var
= variable_from_dropped (dv
, INSERT
);
8563 gcc_checking_assert (var
);
8565 if (!dv_changed_p (dv
))
8567 gcc_checking_assert (!NO_LOC_P (x
));
8568 gcc_checking_assert (var
->var_part
[0].cur_loc
);
8569 gcc_checking_assert (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
));
8570 gcc_checking_assert (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
)->depth
.complexity
);
8572 elcd
->depth
= update_depth (elcd
->depth
, VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var
)->depth
);
8574 return var
->var_part
[0].cur_loc
;
8577 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (x
) = true;
8578 /* This is tentative, but it makes some tests simpler. */
8579 NO_LOC_P (x
) = true;
8581 gcc_checking_assert (var
->n_var_parts
== 1 || from_empty
);
8583 result
= vt_expand_var_loc_chain (var
, regs
, data
, &pending_recursion
);
8585 if (pending_recursion
)
8587 gcc_checking_assert (!result
);
8588 elcd
->pending
.safe_push (x
);
8592 NO_LOC_P (x
) = !result
;
8593 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (x
) = false;
8594 set_dv_changed (dv
, false);
8597 notify_dependents_of_resolved_value (var
, elcd
->vars
);
8603 /* While expanding variables, we may encounter recursion cycles
8604 because of mutual (possibly indirect) dependencies between two
8605 particular variables (or values), say A and B. If we're trying to
8606 expand A when we get to B, which in turn attempts to expand A, if
8607 we can't find any other expansion for B, we'll add B to this
8608 pending-recursion stack, and tentatively return NULL for its
8609 location. This tentative value will be used for any other
8610 occurrences of B, unless A gets some other location, in which case
8611 it will notify B that it is worth another try at computing a
8612 location for it, and it will use the location computed for A then.
8613 At the end of the expansion, the tentative NULL locations become
8614 final for all members of PENDING that didn't get a notification.
8615 This function performs this finalization of NULL locations. */
8618 resolve_expansions_pending_recursion (vec
<rtx
, va_heap
> *pending
)
8620 while (!pending
->is_empty ())
8622 rtx x
= pending
->pop ();
8625 if (!VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (x
))
8628 gcc_checking_assert (NO_LOC_P (x
));
8629 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (x
) = false;
8630 dv
= dv_from_rtx (x
);
8631 gcc_checking_assert (dv_changed_p (dv
));
8632 set_dv_changed (dv
, false);
8636 /* Initialize expand_loc_callback_data D with variable hash table V.
8637 It must be a macro because of alloca (vec stack). */
8638 #define INIT_ELCD(d, v) \
8642 (d).depth.complexity = (d).depth.entryvals = 0; \
8645 /* Finalize expand_loc_callback_data D, resolved to location L. */
8646 #define FINI_ELCD(d, l) \
8649 resolve_expansions_pending_recursion (&(d).pending); \
8650 (d).pending.release (); \
8651 (d).expanding.release (); \
8653 if ((l) && MEM_P (l)) \
8654 (l) = targetm.delegitimize_address (l); \
8658 /* Expand VALUEs and DEBUG_EXPRs in LOC to a location, using the
8659 equivalences in VARS, updating their CUR_LOCs in the process. */
8662 vt_expand_loc (rtx loc
, variable_table_type
*vars
)
8664 class expand_loc_callback_data data
;
8667 if (!MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_BIND_INSNS
)
8670 INIT_ELCD (data
, vars
);
8672 result
= cselib_expand_value_rtx_cb (loc
, scratch_regs
, EXPR_DEPTH
,
8673 vt_expand_loc_callback
, &data
);
8675 FINI_ELCD (data
, result
);
8680 /* Expand the one-part VARiable to a location, using the equivalences
8681 in VARS, updating their CUR_LOCs in the process. */
8684 vt_expand_1pvar (variable
*var
, variable_table_type
*vars
)
8686 class expand_loc_callback_data data
;
8689 gcc_checking_assert (var
->onepart
&& var
->n_var_parts
== 1);
8691 if (!dv_changed_p (var
->dv
))
8692 return var
->var_part
[0].cur_loc
;
8694 INIT_ELCD (data
, vars
);
8696 loc
= vt_expand_var_loc_chain (var
, scratch_regs
, &data
, NULL
);
8698 gcc_checking_assert (data
.expanding
.is_empty ());
8700 FINI_ELCD (data
, loc
);
8705 /* Emit the NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION for variable *VARP. DATA contains
8706 additional parameters: WHERE specifies whether the note shall be emitted
8707 before or after instruction INSN. */
8710 emit_note_insn_var_location (variable
**varp
, emit_note_data
*data
)
8712 variable
*var
= *varp
;
8713 rtx_insn
*insn
= data
->insn
;
8714 enum emit_note_where where
= data
->where
;
8715 variable_table_type
*vars
= data
->vars
;
8718 int i
, j
, n_var_parts
;
8720 enum var_init_status initialized
= VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED
;
8721 HOST_WIDE_INT last_limit
;
8722 HOST_WIDE_INT offsets
[MAX_VAR_PARTS
];
8723 rtx loc
[MAX_VAR_PARTS
];
8727 gcc_checking_assert (var
->onepart
== NOT_ONEPART
8728 || var
->onepart
== ONEPART_VDECL
);
8730 decl
= dv_as_decl (var
->dv
);
8736 for (i
= 0; i
< var
->n_var_parts
; i
++)
8737 if (var
->var_part
[i
].cur_loc
== NULL
&& var
->var_part
[i
].loc_chain
)
8738 var
->var_part
[i
].cur_loc
= var
->var_part
[i
].loc_chain
->loc
;
8739 for (i
= 0; i
< var
->n_var_parts
; i
++)
8741 machine_mode mode
, wider_mode
;
8743 HOST_WIDE_INT offset
, size
, wider_size
;
8745 if (i
== 0 && var
->onepart
)
8747 gcc_checking_assert (var
->n_var_parts
== 1);
8749 initialized
= VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
;
8750 loc2
= vt_expand_1pvar (var
, vars
);
8754 if (last_limit
< VAR_PART_OFFSET (var
, i
))
8759 else if (last_limit
> VAR_PART_OFFSET (var
, i
))
8761 offset
= VAR_PART_OFFSET (var
, i
);
8762 loc2
= var
->var_part
[i
].cur_loc
;
8763 if (loc2
&& GET_CODE (loc2
) == MEM
8764 && GET_CODE (XEXP (loc2
, 0)) == VALUE
)
8766 rtx depval
= XEXP (loc2
, 0);
8768 loc2
= vt_expand_loc (loc2
, vars
);
8771 loc_exp_insert_dep (var
, depval
, vars
);
8778 gcc_checking_assert (GET_CODE (loc2
) != VALUE
);
8779 for (lc
= var
->var_part
[i
].loc_chain
; lc
; lc
= lc
->next
)
8780 if (var
->var_part
[i
].cur_loc
== lc
->loc
)
8782 initialized
= lc
->init
;
8788 offsets
[n_var_parts
] = offset
;
8794 loc
[n_var_parts
] = loc2
;
8795 mode
= GET_MODE (var
->var_part
[i
].cur_loc
);
8796 if (mode
== VOIDmode
&& var
->onepart
)
8797 mode
= DECL_MODE (decl
);
8798 /* We ony track subparts of constant-sized objects, since at present
8799 there's no representation for polynomial pieces. */
8800 if (!GET_MODE_SIZE (mode
).is_constant (&size
))
8805 last_limit
= offsets
[n_var_parts
] + size
;
8807 /* Attempt to merge adjacent registers or memory. */
8808 for (j
= i
+ 1; j
< var
->n_var_parts
; j
++)
8809 if (last_limit
<= VAR_PART_OFFSET (var
, j
))
8811 if (j
< var
->n_var_parts
8812 && GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (mode
).exists (&wider_mode
)
8813 && GET_MODE_SIZE (wider_mode
).is_constant (&wider_size
)
8814 && var
->var_part
[j
].cur_loc
8815 && mode
== GET_MODE (var
->var_part
[j
].cur_loc
)
8816 && (REG_P (loc
[n_var_parts
]) || MEM_P (loc
[n_var_parts
]))
8817 && last_limit
== (var
->onepart
? 0 : VAR_PART_OFFSET (var
, j
))
8818 && (loc2
= vt_expand_loc (var
->var_part
[j
].cur_loc
, vars
))
8819 && GET_CODE (loc
[n_var_parts
]) == GET_CODE (loc2
))
8824 if (REG_P (loc
[n_var_parts
])
8825 && hard_regno_nregs (REGNO (loc
[n_var_parts
]), mode
) * 2
8826 == hard_regno_nregs (REGNO (loc
[n_var_parts
]), wider_mode
)
8827 && end_hard_regno (mode
, REGNO (loc
[n_var_parts
]))
8830 if (! WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
&& ! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
)
8831 new_loc
= simplify_subreg (wider_mode
, loc
[n_var_parts
],
8833 else if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
&& BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
)
8834 new_loc
= simplify_subreg (wider_mode
, loc2
, mode
, 0);
8837 if (!REG_P (new_loc
)
8838 || REGNO (new_loc
) != REGNO (loc
[n_var_parts
]))
8841 REG_ATTRS (new_loc
) = REG_ATTRS (loc
[n_var_parts
]);
8844 else if (MEM_P (loc
[n_var_parts
])
8845 && GET_CODE (XEXP (loc2
, 0)) == PLUS
8846 && REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (loc2
, 0), 0))
8847 && poly_int_rtx_p (XEXP (XEXP (loc2
, 0), 1), &offset2
))
8849 poly_int64 end1
= size
;
8850 rtx base1
= strip_offset_and_add (XEXP (loc
[n_var_parts
], 0),
8852 if (rtx_equal_p (base1
, XEXP (XEXP (loc2
, 0), 0))
8853 && known_eq (end1
, offset2
))
8854 new_loc
= adjust_address_nv (loc
[n_var_parts
],
8860 loc
[n_var_parts
] = new_loc
;
8862 last_limit
= offsets
[n_var_parts
] + wider_size
;
8868 poly_uint64 type_size_unit
8869 = tree_to_poly_uint64 (TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (TREE_TYPE (decl
)));
8870 if (maybe_lt (poly_uint64 (last_limit
), type_size_unit
))
8873 if (! flag_var_tracking_uninit
)
8874 initialized
= VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
;
8878 note_vl
= gen_rtx_VAR_LOCATION (VOIDmode
, decl
, NULL_RTX
, initialized
);
8879 else if (n_var_parts
== 1)
8883 if (offsets
[0] || GET_CODE (loc
[0]) == PARALLEL
)
8884 expr_list
= gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode
, loc
[0], GEN_INT (offsets
[0]));
8888 note_vl
= gen_rtx_VAR_LOCATION (VOIDmode
, decl
, expr_list
, initialized
);
8890 else if (n_var_parts
)
8894 for (i
= 0; i
< n_var_parts
; i
++)
8896 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode
, loc
[i
], GEN_INT (offsets
[i
]));
8898 parallel
= gen_rtx_PARALLEL (VOIDmode
,
8899 gen_rtvec_v (n_var_parts
, loc
));
8900 note_vl
= gen_rtx_VAR_LOCATION (VOIDmode
, decl
,
8901 parallel
, initialized
);
8904 if (where
!= EMIT_NOTE_BEFORE_INSN
)
8906 note
= emit_note_after (NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION
, insn
);
8907 if (where
== EMIT_NOTE_AFTER_CALL_INSN
)
8908 NOTE_DURING_CALL_P (note
) = true;
8912 /* Make sure that the call related notes come first. */
8913 while (NEXT_INSN (insn
)
8915 && NOTE_KIND (insn
) == NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION
8916 && NOTE_DURING_CALL_P (insn
))
8917 insn
= NEXT_INSN (insn
);
8919 && NOTE_KIND (insn
) == NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION
8920 && NOTE_DURING_CALL_P (insn
))
8921 note
= emit_note_after (NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION
, insn
);
8923 note
= emit_note_before (NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION
, insn
);
8925 NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (note
) = note_vl
;
8927 set_dv_changed (var
->dv
, false);
8928 gcc_assert (var
->in_changed_variables
);
8929 var
->in_changed_variables
= false;
8930 changed_variables
->clear_slot (varp
);
8932 /* Continue traversing the hash table. */
8936 /* While traversing changed_variables, push onto DATA (a stack of RTX
8937 values) entries that aren't user variables. */
8940 var_track_values_to_stack (variable
**slot
,
8941 vec
<rtx
, va_heap
> *changed_values_stack
)
8943 variable
*var
= *slot
;
8945 if (var
->onepart
== ONEPART_VALUE
)
8946 changed_values_stack
->safe_push (dv_as_value (var
->dv
));
8947 else if (var
->onepart
== ONEPART_DEXPR
)
8948 changed_values_stack
->safe_push (DECL_RTL_KNOWN_SET (dv_as_decl (var
->dv
)));
8953 /* Remove from changed_variables the entry whose DV corresponds to
8954 value or debug_expr VAL. */
8956 remove_value_from_changed_variables (rtx val
)
8958 decl_or_value dv
= dv_from_rtx (val
);
8962 slot
= changed_variables
->find_slot_with_hash (dv
, dv_htab_hash (dv
),
8965 var
->in_changed_variables
= false;
8966 changed_variables
->clear_slot (slot
);
8969 /* If VAL (a value or debug_expr) has backlinks to variables actively
8970 dependent on it in HTAB or in CHANGED_VARIABLES, mark them as
8971 changed, adding to CHANGED_VALUES_STACK any dependencies that may
8972 have dependencies of their own to notify. */
8975 notify_dependents_of_changed_value (rtx val
, variable_table_type
*htab
,
8976 vec
<rtx
, va_heap
> *changed_values_stack
)
8981 decl_or_value dv
= dv_from_rtx (val
);
8983 slot
= changed_variables
->find_slot_with_hash (dv
, dv_htab_hash (dv
),
8986 slot
= htab
->find_slot_with_hash (dv
, dv_htab_hash (dv
), NO_INSERT
);
8988 slot
= dropped_values
->find_slot_with_hash (dv
, dv_htab_hash (dv
),
8992 while ((led
= VAR_LOC_DEP_LST (var
)))
8994 decl_or_value ldv
= led
->dv
;
8997 /* Deactivate and remove the backlink, as it was “used up”. It
8998 makes no sense to attempt to notify the same entity again:
8999 either it will be recomputed and re-register an active
9000 dependency, or it will still have the changed mark. */
9002 led
->next
->pprev
= led
->pprev
;
9004 *led
->pprev
= led
->next
;
9008 if (dv_changed_p (ldv
))
9011 switch (dv_onepart_p (ldv
))
9015 set_dv_changed (ldv
, true);
9016 changed_values_stack
->safe_push (dv_as_rtx (ldv
));
9020 ivar
= htab
->find_with_hash (ldv
, dv_htab_hash (ldv
));
9021 gcc_checking_assert (!VAR_LOC_DEP_LST (ivar
));
9022 variable_was_changed (ivar
, NULL
);
9027 ivar
= htab
->find_with_hash (ldv
, dv_htab_hash (ldv
));
9030 int i
= ivar
->n_var_parts
;
9033 rtx loc
= ivar
->var_part
[i
].cur_loc
;
9035 if (loc
&& GET_CODE (loc
) == MEM
9036 && XEXP (loc
, 0) == val
)
9038 variable_was_changed (ivar
, NULL
);
9051 /* Take out of changed_variables any entries that don't refer to use
9052 variables. Back-propagate change notifications from values and
9053 debug_exprs to their active dependencies in HTAB or in
9054 CHANGED_VARIABLES. */
9057 process_changed_values (variable_table_type
*htab
)
9061 auto_vec
<rtx
, 20> changed_values_stack
;
9063 /* Move values from changed_variables to changed_values_stack. */
9065 ->traverse
<vec
<rtx
, va_heap
>*, var_track_values_to_stack
>
9066 (&changed_values_stack
);
9068 /* Back-propagate change notifications in values while popping
9069 them from the stack. */
9070 for (n
= i
= changed_values_stack
.length ();
9071 i
> 0; i
= changed_values_stack
.length ())
9073 val
= changed_values_stack
.pop ();
9074 notify_dependents_of_changed_value (val
, htab
, &changed_values_stack
);
9076 /* This condition will hold when visiting each of the entries
9077 originally in changed_variables. We can't remove them
9078 earlier because this could drop the backlinks before we got a
9079 chance to use them. */
9082 remove_value_from_changed_variables (val
);
9088 /* Emit NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION note for each variable from a chain
9089 CHANGED_VARIABLES and delete this chain. WHERE specifies whether
9090 the notes shall be emitted before of after instruction INSN. */
9093 emit_notes_for_changes (rtx_insn
*insn
, enum emit_note_where where
,
9096 emit_note_data data
;
9097 variable_table_type
*htab
= shared_hash_htab (vars
);
9099 if (changed_variables
->is_empty ())
9102 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_BIND_INSNS
)
9103 process_changed_values (htab
);
9110 ->traverse
<emit_note_data
*, emit_note_insn_var_location
> (&data
);
9113 /* Add variable *SLOT to the chain CHANGED_VARIABLES if it differs from the
9114 same variable in hash table DATA or is not there at all. */
9117 emit_notes_for_differences_1 (variable
**slot
, variable_table_type
*new_vars
)
9119 variable
*old_var
, *new_var
;
9122 new_var
= new_vars
->find_with_hash (old_var
->dv
, dv_htab_hash (old_var
->dv
));
9126 /* Variable has disappeared. */
9127 variable
*empty_var
= NULL
;
9129 if (old_var
->onepart
== ONEPART_VALUE
9130 || old_var
->onepart
== ONEPART_DEXPR
)
9132 empty_var
= variable_from_dropped (old_var
->dv
, NO_INSERT
);
9135 gcc_checking_assert (!empty_var
->in_changed_variables
);
9136 if (!VAR_LOC_1PAUX (old_var
))
9138 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (old_var
) = VAR_LOC_1PAUX (empty_var
);
9139 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (empty_var
) = NULL
;
9142 gcc_checking_assert (!VAR_LOC_1PAUX (empty_var
));
9148 empty_var
= onepart_pool_allocate (old_var
->onepart
);
9149 empty_var
->dv
= old_var
->dv
;
9150 empty_var
->refcount
= 0;
9151 empty_var
->n_var_parts
= 0;
9152 empty_var
->onepart
= old_var
->onepart
;
9153 empty_var
->in_changed_variables
= false;
9156 if (empty_var
->onepart
)
9158 /* Propagate the auxiliary data to (ultimately)
9159 changed_variables. */
9160 empty_var
->var_part
[0].loc_chain
= NULL
;
9161 empty_var
->var_part
[0].cur_loc
= NULL
;
9162 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (empty_var
) = VAR_LOC_1PAUX (old_var
);
9163 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (old_var
) = NULL
;
9165 variable_was_changed (empty_var
, NULL
);
9166 /* Continue traversing the hash table. */
9169 /* Update cur_loc and one-part auxiliary data, before new_var goes
9170 through variable_was_changed. */
9171 if (old_var
!= new_var
&& new_var
->onepart
)
9173 gcc_checking_assert (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (new_var
) == NULL
);
9174 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (new_var
) = VAR_LOC_1PAUX (old_var
);
9175 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (old_var
) = NULL
;
9176 new_var
->var_part
[0].cur_loc
= old_var
->var_part
[0].cur_loc
;
9178 if (variable_different_p (old_var
, new_var
))
9179 variable_was_changed (new_var
, NULL
);
9181 /* Continue traversing the hash table. */
9185 /* Add variable *SLOT to the chain CHANGED_VARIABLES if it is not in hash
9189 emit_notes_for_differences_2 (variable
**slot
, variable_table_type
*old_vars
)
9191 variable
*old_var
, *new_var
;
9194 old_var
= old_vars
->find_with_hash (new_var
->dv
, dv_htab_hash (new_var
->dv
));
9198 for (i
= 0; i
< new_var
->n_var_parts
; i
++)
9199 new_var
->var_part
[i
].cur_loc
= NULL
;
9200 variable_was_changed (new_var
, NULL
);
9203 /* Continue traversing the hash table. */
9207 /* Emit notes before INSN for differences between dataflow sets OLD_SET and
9211 emit_notes_for_differences (rtx_insn
*insn
, dataflow_set
*old_set
,
9212 dataflow_set
*new_set
)
9214 shared_hash_htab (old_set
->vars
)
9215 ->traverse
<variable_table_type
*, emit_notes_for_differences_1
>
9216 (shared_hash_htab (new_set
->vars
));
9217 shared_hash_htab (new_set
->vars
)
9218 ->traverse
<variable_table_type
*, emit_notes_for_differences_2
>
9219 (shared_hash_htab (old_set
->vars
));
9220 emit_notes_for_changes (insn
, EMIT_NOTE_BEFORE_INSN
, new_set
->vars
);
9223 /* Return the next insn after INSN that is not a NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION. */
9226 next_non_note_insn_var_location (rtx_insn
*insn
)
9230 insn
= NEXT_INSN (insn
);
9233 || NOTE_KIND (insn
) != NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION
)
9240 /* Emit the notes for changes of location parts in the basic block BB. */
9243 emit_notes_in_bb (basic_block bb
, dataflow_set
*set
)
9246 micro_operation
*mo
;
9248 dataflow_set_clear (set
);
9249 dataflow_set_copy (set
, &VTI (bb
)->in
);
9251 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (VTI (bb
)->mos
, i
, mo
)
9253 rtx_insn
*insn
= mo
->insn
;
9254 rtx_insn
*next_insn
= next_non_note_insn_var_location (insn
);
9259 dataflow_set_clear_at_call (set
, insn
);
9260 emit_notes_for_changes (insn
, EMIT_NOTE_AFTER_CALL_INSN
, set
->vars
);
9262 rtx arguments
= mo
->u
.loc
, *p
= &arguments
;
9265 XEXP (XEXP (*p
, 0), 1)
9266 = vt_expand_loc (XEXP (XEXP (*p
, 0), 1),
9267 shared_hash_htab (set
->vars
));
9268 /* If expansion is successful, keep it in the list. */
9269 if (XEXP (XEXP (*p
, 0), 1))
9271 XEXP (XEXP (*p
, 0), 1)
9272 = copy_rtx_if_shared (XEXP (XEXP (*p
, 0), 1));
9275 /* Otherwise, if the following item is data_value for it,
9277 else if (XEXP (*p
, 1)
9278 && REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (*p
, 0), 0))
9279 && MEM_P (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (*p
, 1), 0), 0))
9280 && REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (*p
, 1), 0), 0),
9282 && REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (*p
, 0), 0))
9283 == REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (*p
, 1), 0),
9285 *p
= XEXP (XEXP (*p
, 1), 1);
9286 /* Just drop this item. */
9290 add_reg_note (insn
, REG_CALL_ARG_LOCATION
, arguments
);
9296 rtx loc
= mo
->u
.loc
;
9299 var_reg_set (set
, loc
, VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED
, NULL
);
9301 var_mem_set (set
, loc
, VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED
, NULL
);
9303 emit_notes_for_changes (insn
, EMIT_NOTE_BEFORE_INSN
, set
->vars
);
9309 rtx loc
= mo
->u
.loc
;
9313 if (GET_CODE (loc
) == CONCAT
)
9315 val
= XEXP (loc
, 0);
9316 vloc
= XEXP (loc
, 1);
9324 var
= PAT_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (vloc
);
9326 clobber_variable_part (set
, NULL_RTX
,
9327 dv_from_decl (var
), 0, NULL_RTX
);
9330 if (VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION (loc
))
9331 val_resolve (set
, val
, PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (vloc
), insn
);
9332 set_variable_part (set
, val
, dv_from_decl (var
), 0,
9333 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
, NULL_RTX
,
9336 else if (!VAR_LOC_UNKNOWN_P (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (vloc
)))
9337 set_variable_part (set
, PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (vloc
),
9338 dv_from_decl (var
), 0,
9339 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
, NULL_RTX
,
9342 emit_notes_for_changes (insn
, EMIT_NOTE_AFTER_INSN
, set
->vars
);
9348 rtx loc
= mo
->u
.loc
;
9349 rtx val
, vloc
, uloc
;
9351 vloc
= uloc
= XEXP (loc
, 1);
9352 val
= XEXP (loc
, 0);
9354 if (GET_CODE (val
) == CONCAT
)
9356 uloc
= XEXP (val
, 1);
9357 val
= XEXP (val
, 0);
9360 if (VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION (loc
))
9361 val_resolve (set
, val
, vloc
, insn
);
9363 val_store (set
, val
, uloc
, insn
, false);
9365 if (VAL_HOLDS_TRACK_EXPR (loc
))
9367 if (GET_CODE (uloc
) == REG
)
9368 var_reg_set (set
, uloc
, VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED
,
9370 else if (GET_CODE (uloc
) == MEM
)
9371 var_mem_set (set
, uloc
, VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED
,
9375 emit_notes_for_changes (insn
, EMIT_NOTE_BEFORE_INSN
, set
->vars
);
9381 rtx loc
= mo
->u
.loc
;
9382 rtx val
, vloc
, uloc
;
9386 uloc
= XEXP (vloc
, 1);
9387 val
= XEXP (vloc
, 0);
9390 if (GET_CODE (uloc
) == SET
)
9392 dstv
= SET_DEST (uloc
);
9393 srcv
= SET_SRC (uloc
);
9401 if (GET_CODE (val
) == CONCAT
)
9403 dstv
= vloc
= XEXP (val
, 1);
9404 val
= XEXP (val
, 0);
9407 if (GET_CODE (vloc
) == SET
)
9409 srcv
= SET_SRC (vloc
);
9411 gcc_assert (val
!= srcv
);
9412 gcc_assert (vloc
== uloc
|| VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION (loc
));
9414 dstv
= vloc
= SET_DEST (vloc
);
9416 if (VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION (loc
))
9417 val_resolve (set
, val
, srcv
, insn
);
9419 else if (VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION (loc
))
9421 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (uloc
) == SET
9422 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (uloc
)) == REG
);
9423 val_resolve (set
, val
, SET_SRC (uloc
), insn
);
9426 if (VAL_HOLDS_TRACK_EXPR (loc
))
9428 if (VAL_EXPR_IS_CLOBBERED (loc
))
9431 var_reg_delete (set
, uloc
, true);
9432 else if (MEM_P (uloc
))
9434 gcc_assert (MEM_P (dstv
));
9435 gcc_assert (MEM_ATTRS (dstv
) == MEM_ATTRS (uloc
));
9436 var_mem_delete (set
, dstv
, true);
9441 bool copied_p
= VAL_EXPR_IS_COPIED (loc
);
9442 rtx src
= NULL
, dst
= uloc
;
9443 enum var_init_status status
= VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
;
9445 if (GET_CODE (uloc
) == SET
)
9447 src
= SET_SRC (uloc
);
9448 dst
= SET_DEST (uloc
);
9453 status
= find_src_status (set
, src
);
9455 src
= find_src_set_src (set
, src
);
9459 var_reg_delete_and_set (set
, dst
, !copied_p
,
9461 else if (MEM_P (dst
))
9463 gcc_assert (MEM_P (dstv
));
9464 gcc_assert (MEM_ATTRS (dstv
) == MEM_ATTRS (dst
));
9465 var_mem_delete_and_set (set
, dstv
, !copied_p
,
9470 else if (REG_P (uloc
))
9471 var_regno_delete (set
, REGNO (uloc
));
9472 else if (MEM_P (uloc
))
9474 gcc_checking_assert (GET_CODE (vloc
) == MEM
);
9475 gcc_checking_assert (vloc
== dstv
);
9477 clobber_overlapping_mems (set
, vloc
);
9480 val_store (set
, val
, dstv
, insn
, true);
9482 emit_notes_for_changes (next_insn
, EMIT_NOTE_BEFORE_INSN
,
9489 rtx loc
= mo
->u
.loc
;
9492 if (GET_CODE (loc
) == SET
)
9494 set_src
= SET_SRC (loc
);
9495 loc
= SET_DEST (loc
);
9499 var_reg_delete_and_set (set
, loc
, true, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
,
9502 var_mem_delete_and_set (set
, loc
, true, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
,
9505 emit_notes_for_changes (next_insn
, EMIT_NOTE_BEFORE_INSN
,
9512 rtx loc
= mo
->u
.loc
;
9513 enum var_init_status src_status
;
9516 if (GET_CODE (loc
) == SET
)
9518 set_src
= SET_SRC (loc
);
9519 loc
= SET_DEST (loc
);
9522 src_status
= find_src_status (set
, set_src
);
9523 set_src
= find_src_set_src (set
, set_src
);
9526 var_reg_delete_and_set (set
, loc
, false, src_status
, set_src
);
9528 var_mem_delete_and_set (set
, loc
, false, src_status
, set_src
);
9530 emit_notes_for_changes (next_insn
, EMIT_NOTE_BEFORE_INSN
,
9537 rtx loc
= mo
->u
.loc
;
9540 var_reg_delete (set
, loc
, false);
9542 var_mem_delete (set
, loc
, false);
9544 emit_notes_for_changes (insn
, EMIT_NOTE_AFTER_INSN
, set
->vars
);
9550 rtx loc
= mo
->u
.loc
;
9553 var_reg_delete (set
, loc
, true);
9555 var_mem_delete (set
, loc
, true);
9557 emit_notes_for_changes (next_insn
, EMIT_NOTE_BEFORE_INSN
,
9563 set
->stack_adjust
+= mo
->u
.adjust
;
9569 /* Emit notes for the whole function. */
9572 vt_emit_notes (void)
9577 gcc_assert (changed_variables
->is_empty ());
9579 /* Free memory occupied by the out hash tables, as they aren't used
9581 FOR_EACH_BB_FN (bb
, cfun
)
9582 dataflow_set_clear (&VTI (bb
)->out
);
9584 /* Enable emitting notes by functions (mainly by set_variable_part and
9585 delete_variable_part). */
9588 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_BIND_INSNS
)
9589 dropped_values
= new variable_table_type (cselib_get_next_uid () * 2);
9591 dataflow_set_init (&cur
);
9593 FOR_EACH_BB_FN (bb
, cfun
)
9595 /* Emit the notes for changes of variable locations between two
9596 subsequent basic blocks. */
9597 emit_notes_for_differences (BB_HEAD (bb
), &cur
, &VTI (bb
)->in
);
9599 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_BIND_INSNS
)
9600 local_get_addr_cache
= new hash_map
<rtx
, rtx
>;
9602 /* Emit the notes for the changes in the basic block itself. */
9603 emit_notes_in_bb (bb
, &cur
);
9605 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_BIND_INSNS
)
9606 delete local_get_addr_cache
;
9607 local_get_addr_cache
= NULL
;
9609 /* Free memory occupied by the in hash table, we won't need it
9611 dataflow_set_clear (&VTI (bb
)->in
);
9615 shared_hash_htab (cur
.vars
)
9616 ->traverse
<variable_table_type
*, emit_notes_for_differences_1
>
9617 (shared_hash_htab (empty_shared_hash
));
9619 dataflow_set_destroy (&cur
);
9621 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_BIND_INSNS
)
9622 delete dropped_values
;
9623 dropped_values
= NULL
;
9628 /* If there is a declaration and offset associated with register/memory RTL
9629 assign declaration to *DECLP and offset to *OFFSETP, and return true. */
9632 vt_get_decl_and_offset (rtx rtl
, tree
*declp
, poly_int64
*offsetp
)
9636 if (REG_ATTRS (rtl
))
9638 *declp
= REG_EXPR (rtl
);
9639 *offsetp
= REG_OFFSET (rtl
);
9643 else if (GET_CODE (rtl
) == PARALLEL
)
9645 tree decl
= NULL_TREE
;
9646 HOST_WIDE_INT offset
= MAX_VAR_PARTS
;
9647 int len
= XVECLEN (rtl
, 0), i
;
9649 for (i
= 0; i
< len
; i
++)
9651 rtx reg
= XEXP (XVECEXP (rtl
, 0, i
), 0);
9652 if (!REG_P (reg
) || !REG_ATTRS (reg
))
9655 decl
= REG_EXPR (reg
);
9656 if (REG_EXPR (reg
) != decl
)
9658 HOST_WIDE_INT this_offset
;
9659 if (!track_offset_p (REG_OFFSET (reg
), &this_offset
))
9661 offset
= MIN (offset
, this_offset
);
9671 else if (MEM_P (rtl
))
9673 if (MEM_ATTRS (rtl
))
9675 *declp
= MEM_EXPR (rtl
);
9676 *offsetp
= int_mem_offset (rtl
);
9683 /* Record the value for the ENTRY_VALUE of RTL as a global equivalence
9687 record_entry_value (cselib_val
*val
, rtx rtl
)
9689 rtx ev
= gen_rtx_ENTRY_VALUE (GET_MODE (rtl
));
9691 ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (ev
) = rtl
;
9693 cselib_add_permanent_equiv (val
, ev
, get_insns ());
9696 /* Insert function parameter PARM in IN and OUT sets of ENTRY_BLOCK. */
9699 vt_add_function_parameter (tree parm
)
9701 rtx decl_rtl
= DECL_RTL_IF_SET (parm
);
9702 rtx incoming
= DECL_INCOMING_RTL (parm
);
9708 bool incoming_ok
= true;
9710 if (TREE_CODE (parm
) != PARM_DECL
)
9713 if (!decl_rtl
|| !incoming
)
9716 if (GET_MODE (decl_rtl
) == BLKmode
|| GET_MODE (incoming
) == BLKmode
)
9719 /* If there is a DRAP register or a pseudo in internal_arg_pointer,
9720 rewrite the incoming location of parameters passed on the stack
9721 into MEMs based on the argument pointer, so that incoming doesn't
9722 depend on a pseudo. */
9723 poly_int64 incoming_offset
= 0;
9724 if (MEM_P (incoming
)
9725 && (strip_offset (XEXP (incoming
, 0), &incoming_offset
)
9726 == crtl
->args
.internal_arg_pointer
))
9728 HOST_WIDE_INT off
= -FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (current_function_decl
);
9730 = replace_equiv_address_nv (incoming
,
9731 plus_constant (Pmode
,
9733 off
+ incoming_offset
));
9736 #ifdef HAVE_window_save
9737 /* DECL_INCOMING_RTL uses the INCOMING_REGNO of parameter registers.
9738 If the target machine has an explicit window save instruction, the
9739 actual entry value is the corresponding OUTGOING_REGNO instead. */
9740 if (HAVE_window_save
&& !crtl
->uses_only_leaf_regs
)
9742 if (REG_P (incoming
)
9743 && HARD_REGISTER_P (incoming
)
9744 && OUTGOING_REGNO (REGNO (incoming
)) != REGNO (incoming
))
9747 p
.incoming
= incoming
;
9749 = gen_rtx_REG_offset (incoming
, GET_MODE (incoming
),
9750 OUTGOING_REGNO (REGNO (incoming
)), 0);
9751 p
.outgoing
= incoming
;
9752 vec_safe_push (windowed_parm_regs
, p
);
9754 else if (GET_CODE (incoming
) == PARALLEL
)
9757 = gen_rtx_PARALLEL (VOIDmode
, rtvec_alloc (XVECLEN (incoming
, 0)));
9760 for (i
= 0; i
< XVECLEN (incoming
, 0); i
++)
9762 rtx reg
= XEXP (XVECEXP (incoming
, 0, i
), 0);
9765 reg
= gen_rtx_REG_offset (reg
, GET_MODE (reg
),
9766 OUTGOING_REGNO (REGNO (reg
)), 0);
9768 XVECEXP (outgoing
, 0, i
)
9769 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode
, reg
,
9770 XEXP (XVECEXP (incoming
, 0, i
), 1));
9771 vec_safe_push (windowed_parm_regs
, p
);
9774 incoming
= outgoing
;
9776 else if (MEM_P (incoming
)
9777 && REG_P (XEXP (incoming
, 0))
9778 && HARD_REGISTER_P (XEXP (incoming
, 0)))
9780 rtx reg
= XEXP (incoming
, 0);
9781 if (OUTGOING_REGNO (REGNO (reg
)) != REGNO (reg
))
9785 reg
= gen_raw_REG (GET_MODE (reg
), OUTGOING_REGNO (REGNO (reg
)));
9787 vec_safe_push (windowed_parm_regs
, p
);
9788 incoming
= replace_equiv_address_nv (incoming
, reg
);
9794 if (!vt_get_decl_and_offset (incoming
, &decl
, &offset
))
9796 incoming_ok
= false;
9797 if (MEM_P (incoming
))
9799 /* This means argument is passed by invisible reference. */
9805 if (!vt_get_decl_and_offset (decl_rtl
, &decl
, &offset
))
9807 offset
+= byte_lowpart_offset (GET_MODE (incoming
),
9808 GET_MODE (decl_rtl
));
9817 /* If that DECL_RTL wasn't a pseudo that got spilled to
9818 memory, bail out. Otherwise, the spill slot sharing code
9819 will force the memory to reference spill_slot_decl (%sfp),
9820 so we don't match above. That's ok, the pseudo must have
9821 referenced the entire parameter, so just reset OFFSET. */
9822 if (decl
!= get_spill_slot_decl (false))
9827 HOST_WIDE_INT const_offset
;
9828 if (!track_loc_p (incoming
, parm
, offset
, false, &mode
, &const_offset
))
9831 out
= &VTI (ENTRY_BLOCK_PTR_FOR_FN (cfun
))->out
;
9833 dv
= dv_from_decl (parm
);
9835 if (target_for_debug_bind (parm
)
9836 /* We can't deal with these right now, because this kind of
9837 variable is single-part. ??? We could handle parallels
9838 that describe multiple locations for the same single
9839 value, but ATM we don't. */
9840 && GET_CODE (incoming
) != PARALLEL
)
9845 /* ??? We shouldn't ever hit this, but it may happen because
9846 arguments passed by invisible reference aren't dealt with
9847 above: incoming-rtl will have Pmode rather than the
9848 expected mode for the type. */
9852 lowpart
= var_lowpart (mode
, incoming
);
9856 val
= cselib_lookup_from_insn (lowpart
, mode
, true,
9857 VOIDmode
, get_insns ());
9859 /* ??? Float-typed values in memory are not handled by
9863 preserve_value (val
);
9864 set_variable_part (out
, val
->val_rtx
, dv
, const_offset
,
9865 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
, NULL
, INSERT
);
9866 dv
= dv_from_value (val
->val_rtx
);
9869 if (MEM_P (incoming
))
9871 val
= cselib_lookup_from_insn (XEXP (incoming
, 0), mode
, true,
9872 VOIDmode
, get_insns ());
9875 preserve_value (val
);
9876 incoming
= replace_equiv_address_nv (incoming
, val
->val_rtx
);
9881 if (REG_P (incoming
))
9883 incoming
= var_lowpart (mode
, incoming
);
9884 gcc_assert (REGNO (incoming
) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
);
9885 attrs_list_insert (&out
->regs
[REGNO (incoming
)], dv
, const_offset
,
9887 set_variable_part (out
, incoming
, dv
, const_offset
,
9888 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
, NULL
, INSERT
);
9889 if (dv_is_value_p (dv
))
9891 record_entry_value (CSELIB_VAL_PTR (dv_as_value (dv
)), incoming
);
9892 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (parm
)) == REFERENCE_TYPE
9893 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (parm
))))
9895 machine_mode indmode
9896 = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (parm
)));
9897 rtx mem
= gen_rtx_MEM (indmode
, incoming
);
9898 cselib_val
*val
= cselib_lookup_from_insn (mem
, indmode
, true,
9903 preserve_value (val
);
9904 record_entry_value (val
, mem
);
9905 set_variable_part (out
, mem
, dv_from_value (val
->val_rtx
), 0,
9906 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
, NULL
, INSERT
);
9910 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode
) == MODE_INT
)
9912 machine_mode wider_mode_iter
;
9913 FOR_EACH_WIDER_MODE (wider_mode_iter
, mode
)
9915 if (!HWI_COMPUTABLE_MODE_P (wider_mode_iter
))
9918 = gen_rtx_REG (wider_mode_iter
, REGNO (incoming
));
9919 cselib_val
*wider_val
9920 = cselib_lookup_from_insn (wider_reg
, wider_mode_iter
, 1,
9921 VOIDmode
, get_insns ());
9922 preserve_value (wider_val
);
9923 record_entry_value (wider_val
, wider_reg
);
9928 else if (GET_CODE (incoming
) == PARALLEL
&& !dv_onepart_p (dv
))
9932 /* The following code relies on vt_get_decl_and_offset returning true for
9933 incoming, which might not be always the case. */
9936 for (i
= 0; i
< XVECLEN (incoming
, 0); i
++)
9938 rtx reg
= XEXP (XVECEXP (incoming
, 0, i
), 0);
9939 /* vt_get_decl_and_offset has already checked that the offset
9940 is a valid variable part. */
9941 const_offset
= get_tracked_reg_offset (reg
);
9942 gcc_assert (REGNO (reg
) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
);
9943 attrs_list_insert (&out
->regs
[REGNO (reg
)], dv
, const_offset
, reg
);
9944 set_variable_part (out
, reg
, dv
, const_offset
,
9945 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
, NULL
, INSERT
);
9948 else if (MEM_P (incoming
))
9950 incoming
= var_lowpart (mode
, incoming
);
9951 set_variable_part (out
, incoming
, dv
, const_offset
,
9952 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
, NULL
, INSERT
);
9956 /* Insert function parameters to IN and OUT sets of ENTRY_BLOCK. */
9959 vt_add_function_parameters (void)
9963 for (parm
= DECL_ARGUMENTS (current_function_decl
);
9964 parm
; parm
= DECL_CHAIN (parm
))
9965 vt_add_function_parameter (parm
);
9967 if (DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P (DECL_RESULT (current_function_decl
)))
9969 tree vexpr
= DECL_VALUE_EXPR (DECL_RESULT (current_function_decl
));
9971 if (TREE_CODE (vexpr
) == INDIRECT_REF
)
9972 vexpr
= TREE_OPERAND (vexpr
, 0);
9974 if (TREE_CODE (vexpr
) == PARM_DECL
9975 && DECL_ARTIFICIAL (vexpr
)
9976 && !DECL_IGNORED_P (vexpr
)
9977 && DECL_NAMELESS (vexpr
))
9978 vt_add_function_parameter (vexpr
);
9982 /* Initialize cfa_base_rtx, create a preserved VALUE for it and
9983 ensure it isn't flushed during cselib_reset_table.
9984 Can be called only if frame_pointer_rtx resp. arg_pointer_rtx
9985 has been eliminated. */
9988 vt_init_cfa_base (void)
9992 #ifdef FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET
9993 cfa_base_rtx
= frame_pointer_rtx
;
9994 cfa_base_offset
= -FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl
);
9996 cfa_base_rtx
= arg_pointer_rtx
;
9997 cfa_base_offset
= -ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl
);
9999 if (cfa_base_rtx
== hard_frame_pointer_rtx
10000 || !fixed_regs
[REGNO (cfa_base_rtx
)])
10002 cfa_base_rtx
= NULL_RTX
;
10005 if (!MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_BIND_INSNS
)
10008 /* Tell alias analysis that cfa_base_rtx should share
10009 find_base_term value with stack pointer or hard frame pointer. */
10010 if (!frame_pointer_needed
)
10011 vt_equate_reg_base_value (cfa_base_rtx
, stack_pointer_rtx
);
10012 else if (!crtl
->stack_realign_tried
)
10013 vt_equate_reg_base_value (cfa_base_rtx
, hard_frame_pointer_rtx
);
10015 val
= cselib_lookup_from_insn (cfa_base_rtx
, GET_MODE (cfa_base_rtx
), 1,
10016 VOIDmode
, get_insns ());
10017 preserve_value (val
);
10018 cselib_preserve_cfa_base_value (val
, REGNO (cfa_base_rtx
));
10021 /* Reemit INSN, a MARKER_DEBUG_INSN, as a note. */
10024 reemit_marker_as_note (rtx_insn
*insn
)
10026 gcc_checking_assert (DEBUG_MARKER_INSN_P (insn
));
10028 enum insn_note kind
= INSN_DEBUG_MARKER_KIND (insn
);
10032 case NOTE_INSN_BEGIN_STMT
:
10033 case NOTE_INSN_INLINE_ENTRY
:
10035 rtx_insn
*note
= NULL
;
10036 if (cfun
->debug_nonbind_markers
)
10038 note
= emit_note_before (kind
, insn
);
10039 NOTE_MARKER_LOCATION (note
) = INSN_LOCATION (insn
);
10041 delete_insn (insn
);
10046 gcc_unreachable ();
10050 /* Allocate and initialize the data structures for variable tracking
10051 and parse the RTL to get the micro operations. */
10054 vt_initialize (void)
10057 poly_int64 fp_cfa_offset
= -1;
10059 alloc_aux_for_blocks (sizeof (variable_tracking_info
));
10061 empty_shared_hash
= shared_hash_pool
.allocate ();
10062 empty_shared_hash
->refcount
= 1;
10063 empty_shared_hash
->htab
= new variable_table_type (1);
10064 changed_variables
= new variable_table_type (10);
10066 /* Init the IN and OUT sets. */
10067 FOR_ALL_BB_FN (bb
, cfun
)
10069 VTI (bb
)->visited
= false;
10070 VTI (bb
)->flooded
= false;
10071 dataflow_set_init (&VTI (bb
)->in
);
10072 dataflow_set_init (&VTI (bb
)->out
);
10073 VTI (bb
)->permp
= NULL
;
10076 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_BIND_INSNS
)
10078 cselib_init (CSELIB_RECORD_MEMORY
| CSELIB_PRESERVE_CONSTANTS
);
10079 scratch_regs
= BITMAP_ALLOC (NULL
);
10080 preserved_values
.create (256);
10081 global_get_addr_cache
= new hash_map
<rtx
, rtx
>;
10085 scratch_regs
= NULL
;
10086 global_get_addr_cache
= NULL
;
10089 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_BIND_INSNS
)
10095 #ifdef FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET
10096 reg
= frame_pointer_rtx
;
10097 ofst
= FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl
);
10099 reg
= arg_pointer_rtx
;
10100 ofst
= ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl
);
10103 ofst
-= INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
;
10105 val
= cselib_lookup_from_insn (reg
, GET_MODE (reg
), 1,
10106 VOIDmode
, get_insns ());
10107 preserve_value (val
);
10108 if (reg
!= hard_frame_pointer_rtx
&& fixed_regs
[REGNO (reg
)])
10109 cselib_preserve_cfa_base_value (val
, REGNO (reg
));
10113 = cselib_lookup_from_insn (stack_pointer_rtx
,
10114 GET_MODE (stack_pointer_rtx
), 1,
10115 VOIDmode
, get_insns ());
10116 preserve_value (valsp
);
10117 expr
= plus_constant (GET_MODE (reg
), reg
, ofst
);
10118 /* This cselib_add_permanent_equiv call needs to be done before
10119 the other cselib_add_permanent_equiv a few lines later,
10120 because after that one is done, cselib_lookup on this expr
10121 will due to the cselib SP_DERIVED_VALUE_P optimizations
10122 return valsp and so no permanent equivalency will be added. */
10123 cselib_add_permanent_equiv (valsp
, expr
, get_insns ());
10126 expr
= plus_constant (GET_MODE (stack_pointer_rtx
),
10127 stack_pointer_rtx
, -ofst
);
10128 cselib_add_permanent_equiv (val
, expr
, get_insns ());
10131 /* In order to factor out the adjustments made to the stack pointer or to
10132 the hard frame pointer and thus be able to use DW_OP_fbreg operations
10133 instead of individual location lists, we're going to rewrite MEMs based
10134 on them into MEMs based on the CFA by de-eliminating stack_pointer_rtx
10135 or hard_frame_pointer_rtx to the virtual CFA pointer frame_pointer_rtx
10136 resp. arg_pointer_rtx. We can do this either when there is no frame
10137 pointer in the function and stack adjustments are consistent for all
10138 basic blocks or when there is a frame pointer and no stack realignment.
10139 But we first have to check that frame_pointer_rtx resp. arg_pointer_rtx
10140 has been eliminated. */
10141 if (!frame_pointer_needed
)
10145 if (!vt_stack_adjustments ())
10148 #ifdef FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET
10149 reg
= frame_pointer_rtx
;
10151 reg
= arg_pointer_rtx
;
10153 elim
= eliminate_regs (reg
, VOIDmode
, NULL_RTX
);
10156 if (GET_CODE (elim
) == PLUS
)
10157 elim
= XEXP (elim
, 0);
10158 if (elim
== stack_pointer_rtx
)
10159 vt_init_cfa_base ();
10162 else if (!crtl
->stack_realign_tried
)
10166 #ifdef FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET
10167 reg
= frame_pointer_rtx
;
10168 fp_cfa_offset
= FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl
);
10170 reg
= arg_pointer_rtx
;
10171 fp_cfa_offset
= ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl
);
10173 elim
= eliminate_regs (reg
, VOIDmode
, NULL_RTX
);
10176 if (GET_CODE (elim
) == PLUS
)
10178 fp_cfa_offset
-= rtx_to_poly_int64 (XEXP (elim
, 1));
10179 elim
= XEXP (elim
, 0);
10181 if (elim
!= hard_frame_pointer_rtx
)
10182 fp_cfa_offset
= -1;
10185 fp_cfa_offset
= -1;
10188 /* If the stack is realigned and a DRAP register is used, we're going to
10189 rewrite MEMs based on it representing incoming locations of parameters
10190 passed on the stack into MEMs based on the argument pointer. Although
10191 we aren't going to rewrite other MEMs, we still need to initialize the
10192 virtual CFA pointer in order to ensure that the argument pointer will
10193 be seen as a constant throughout the function.
10195 ??? This doesn't work if FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET is defined. */
10196 else if (stack_realign_drap
)
10200 #ifdef FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET
10201 reg
= frame_pointer_rtx
;
10203 reg
= arg_pointer_rtx
;
10205 elim
= eliminate_regs (reg
, VOIDmode
, NULL_RTX
);
10208 if (GET_CODE (elim
) == PLUS
)
10209 elim
= XEXP (elim
, 0);
10210 if (elim
== hard_frame_pointer_rtx
)
10211 vt_init_cfa_base ();
10215 hard_frame_pointer_adjustment
= -1;
10217 vt_add_function_parameters ();
10219 bool record_sp_value
= false;
10220 FOR_EACH_BB_FN (bb
, cfun
)
10223 basic_block first_bb
, last_bb
;
10225 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_BIND_INSNS
)
10227 cselib_record_sets_hook
= add_with_sets
;
10228 if (dump_file
&& (dump_flags
& TDF_DETAILS
))
10229 fprintf (dump_file
, "first value: %i\n",
10230 cselib_get_next_uid ());
10233 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_BIND_INSNS
10235 && !frame_pointer_needed
10236 && record_sp_value
)
10237 cselib_record_sp_cfa_base_equiv (-cfa_base_offset
10238 - VTI (bb
)->in
.stack_adjust
,
10240 record_sp_value
= true;
10246 if (bb
->next_bb
== EXIT_BLOCK_PTR_FOR_FN (cfun
)
10247 || ! single_pred_p (bb
->next_bb
))
10249 e
= find_edge (bb
, bb
->next_bb
);
10250 if (! e
|| (e
->flags
& EDGE_FALLTHRU
) == 0)
10256 /* Add the micro-operations to the vector. */
10257 FOR_BB_BETWEEN (bb
, first_bb
, last_bb
->next_bb
, next_bb
)
10259 HOST_WIDE_INT offset
= VTI (bb
)->out
.stack_adjust
;
10260 VTI (bb
)->out
.stack_adjust
= VTI (bb
)->in
.stack_adjust
;
10263 FOR_BB_INSNS_SAFE (bb
, insn
, next
)
10267 HOST_WIDE_INT pre
= 0, post
= 0;
10269 if (!frame_pointer_needed
)
10271 insn_stack_adjust_offset_pre_post (insn
, &pre
, &post
);
10274 micro_operation mo
;
10275 mo
.type
= MO_ADJUST
;
10278 if (dump_file
&& (dump_flags
& TDF_DETAILS
))
10279 log_op_type (PATTERN (insn
), bb
, insn
,
10280 MO_ADJUST
, dump_file
);
10281 VTI (bb
)->mos
.safe_push (mo
);
10285 cselib_hook_called
= false;
10286 adjust_insn (bb
, insn
);
10289 VTI (bb
)->out
.stack_adjust
+= pre
;
10291 if (DEBUG_MARKER_INSN_P (insn
))
10293 reemit_marker_as_note (insn
);
10297 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_BIND_INSNS
)
10300 prepare_call_arguments (bb
, insn
);
10301 cselib_process_insn (insn
);
10302 if (dump_file
&& (dump_flags
& TDF_DETAILS
))
10304 if (dump_flags
& TDF_SLIM
)
10305 dump_insn_slim (dump_file
, insn
);
10307 print_rtl_single (dump_file
, insn
);
10308 dump_cselib_table (dump_file
);
10311 if (!cselib_hook_called
)
10312 add_with_sets (insn
, 0, 0);
10313 cancel_changes (0);
10317 micro_operation mo
;
10318 mo
.type
= MO_ADJUST
;
10319 mo
.u
.adjust
= post
;
10321 if (dump_file
&& (dump_flags
& TDF_DETAILS
))
10322 log_op_type (PATTERN (insn
), bb
, insn
,
10323 MO_ADJUST
, dump_file
);
10324 VTI (bb
)->mos
.safe_push (mo
);
10325 VTI (bb
)->out
.stack_adjust
+= post
;
10328 if (maybe_ne (fp_cfa_offset
, -1)
10329 && known_eq (hard_frame_pointer_adjustment
, -1)
10330 && fp_setter_insn (insn
))
10332 vt_init_cfa_base ();
10333 hard_frame_pointer_adjustment
= fp_cfa_offset
;
10334 /* Disassociate sp from fp now. */
10335 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_BIND_INSNS
)
10338 cselib_invalidate_rtx (stack_pointer_rtx
);
10339 v
= cselib_lookup (stack_pointer_rtx
, Pmode
, 1,
10341 if (v
&& !cselib_preserved_value_p (v
))
10343 cselib_set_value_sp_based (v
);
10344 preserve_value (v
);
10350 gcc_assert (offset
== VTI (bb
)->out
.stack_adjust
);
10355 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_BIND_INSNS
)
10357 cselib_preserve_only_values ();
10358 cselib_reset_table (cselib_get_next_uid ());
10359 cselib_record_sets_hook
= NULL
;
10363 hard_frame_pointer_adjustment
= -1;
10364 VTI (ENTRY_BLOCK_PTR_FOR_FN (cfun
))->flooded
= true;
10365 cfa_base_rtx
= NULL_RTX
;
10369 /* This is *not* reset after each function. It gives each
10370 NOTE_INSN_DELETED_DEBUG_LABEL in the entire compilation
10371 a unique label number. */
10373 static int debug_label_num
= 1;
10375 /* Remove from the insn stream a single debug insn used for
10376 variable tracking at assignments. */
10379 delete_vta_debug_insn (rtx_insn
*insn
)
10381 if (DEBUG_MARKER_INSN_P (insn
))
10383 reemit_marker_as_note (insn
);
10387 tree decl
= INSN_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (insn
);
10388 if (TREE_CODE (decl
) == LABEL_DECL
10389 && DECL_NAME (decl
)
10390 && !DECL_RTL_SET_P (decl
))
10392 PUT_CODE (insn
, NOTE
);
10393 NOTE_KIND (insn
) = NOTE_INSN_DELETED_DEBUG_LABEL
;
10394 NOTE_DELETED_LABEL_NAME (insn
)
10395 = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (decl
));
10396 SET_DECL_RTL (decl
, insn
);
10397 CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn
) = debug_label_num
++;
10400 delete_insn (insn
);
10403 /* Remove from the insn stream all debug insns used for variable
10404 tracking at assignments. USE_CFG should be false if the cfg is no
10408 delete_vta_debug_insns (bool use_cfg
)
10411 rtx_insn
*insn
, *next
;
10413 if (!MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_INSNS
)
10417 FOR_EACH_BB_FN (bb
, cfun
)
10419 FOR_BB_INSNS_SAFE (bb
, insn
, next
)
10420 if (DEBUG_INSN_P (insn
))
10421 delete_vta_debug_insn (insn
);
10424 for (insn
= get_insns (); insn
; insn
= next
)
10426 next
= NEXT_INSN (insn
);
10427 if (DEBUG_INSN_P (insn
))
10428 delete_vta_debug_insn (insn
);
10432 /* Run a fast, BB-local only version of var tracking, to take care of
10433 information that we don't do global analysis on, such that not all
10434 information is lost. If SKIPPED holds, we're skipping the global
10435 pass entirely, so we should try to use information it would have
10436 handled as well.. */
10439 vt_debug_insns_local (bool skipped ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
)
10441 /* ??? Just skip it all for now. */
10442 delete_vta_debug_insns (true);
10445 /* Free the data structures needed for variable tracking. */
10452 FOR_EACH_BB_FN (bb
, cfun
)
10454 VTI (bb
)->mos
.release ();
10457 FOR_ALL_BB_FN (bb
, cfun
)
10459 dataflow_set_destroy (&VTI (bb
)->in
);
10460 dataflow_set_destroy (&VTI (bb
)->out
);
10461 if (VTI (bb
)->permp
)
10463 dataflow_set_destroy (VTI (bb
)->permp
);
10464 XDELETE (VTI (bb
)->permp
);
10467 free_aux_for_blocks ();
10468 delete empty_shared_hash
->htab
;
10469 empty_shared_hash
->htab
= NULL
;
10470 delete changed_variables
;
10471 changed_variables
= NULL
;
10472 attrs_pool
.release ();
10473 var_pool
.release ();
10474 location_chain_pool
.release ();
10475 shared_hash_pool
.release ();
10477 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_BIND_INSNS
)
10479 if (global_get_addr_cache
)
10480 delete global_get_addr_cache
;
10481 global_get_addr_cache
= NULL
;
10482 loc_exp_dep_pool
.release ();
10483 valvar_pool
.release ();
10484 preserved_values
.release ();
10486 BITMAP_FREE (scratch_regs
);
10487 scratch_regs
= NULL
;
10490 #ifdef HAVE_window_save
10491 vec_free (windowed_parm_regs
);
10495 XDELETEVEC (vui_vec
);
10500 /* The entry point to variable tracking pass. */
10502 static inline unsigned int
10503 variable_tracking_main_1 (void)
10507 /* We won't be called as a separate pass if flag_var_tracking is not
10508 set, but final may call us to turn debug markers into notes. */
10509 if ((!flag_var_tracking
&& MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_INSNS
)
10510 || flag_var_tracking_assignments
< 0
10511 /* Var-tracking right now assumes the IR doesn't contain
10512 any pseudos at this point. */
10513 || targetm
.no_register_allocation
)
10515 delete_vta_debug_insns (true);
10519 if (!flag_var_tracking
)
10522 if (n_basic_blocks_for_fn (cfun
) > 500
10523 && n_edges_for_fn (cfun
) / n_basic_blocks_for_fn (cfun
) >= 20)
10525 vt_debug_insns_local (true);
10529 if (!vt_initialize ())
10532 vt_debug_insns_local (true);
10536 success
= vt_find_locations ();
10538 if (!success
&& flag_var_tracking_assignments
> 0)
10542 delete_vta_debug_insns (true);
10544 /* This is later restored by our caller. */
10545 flag_var_tracking_assignments
= 0;
10547 success
= vt_initialize ();
10548 gcc_assert (success
);
10550 success
= vt_find_locations ();
10556 vt_debug_insns_local (false);
10560 if (dump_file
&& (dump_flags
& TDF_DETAILS
))
10562 dump_dataflow_sets ();
10563 dump_reg_info (dump_file
);
10564 dump_flow_info (dump_file
, dump_flags
);
10567 timevar_push (TV_VAR_TRACKING_EMIT
);
10569 timevar_pop (TV_VAR_TRACKING_EMIT
);
10572 vt_debug_insns_local (false);
10577 variable_tracking_main (void)
10580 int save
= flag_var_tracking_assignments
;
10582 ret
= variable_tracking_main_1 ();
10584 flag_var_tracking_assignments
= save
;
10591 const pass_data pass_data_variable_tracking
=
10593 RTL_PASS
, /* type */
10594 "vartrack", /* name */
10595 OPTGROUP_NONE
, /* optinfo_flags */
10596 TV_VAR_TRACKING
, /* tv_id */
10597 0, /* properties_required */
10598 0, /* properties_provided */
10599 0, /* properties_destroyed */
10600 0, /* todo_flags_start */
10601 0, /* todo_flags_finish */
10604 class pass_variable_tracking
: public rtl_opt_pass
10607 pass_variable_tracking (gcc::context
*ctxt
)
10608 : rtl_opt_pass (pass_data_variable_tracking
, ctxt
)
10611 /* opt_pass methods: */
10612 bool gate (function
*) final override
10614 return (flag_var_tracking
&& !targetm
.delay_vartrack
);
10617 unsigned int execute (function
*) final override
10619 return variable_tracking_main ();
10622 }; // class pass_variable_tracking
10624 } // anon namespace
10627 make_pass_variable_tracking (gcc::context
*ctxt
)
10629 return new pass_variable_tracking (ctxt
);